blob: d844a1a3c6368dedf3affd6647eef635186e9733 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet7782e232022-03-14 17:31:12 +01007 2022/03/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400340over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400384 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400386 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600615quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400693Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600694that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600699Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
700if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
701or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
702
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
706
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100707When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
708double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600709and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100710a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
711a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
712the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
713regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
714around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
715more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200716
717
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007182.3. Environment variables
719--------------------------
720
721HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
722interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
723configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
724optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
725shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200726underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
727list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
728arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
729before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730
731 Example:
732
733 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
734
735 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
736
737 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
738
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
740file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
743 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
744
745* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
746 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
747 directory.
748
749* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
750
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500751* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752 processes, separated by semicolons.
753
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500754* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200755 CLI, separated by semicolons.
756
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200757In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
758regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
759only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
760
761* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
762
763* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
764 starting at one.
765
766* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
767 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
768 first section.
769
770These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
771if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
772section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
773"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
774proxies.
775
776This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
777logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
778to name some config objects like servers for example.
779
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200780See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200781
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100782
7832.4. Conditional blocks
784-----------------------
785
786It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
787some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
788ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
789configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
790versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
791preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
792text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
793lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
794switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
795are defined to form conditional blocks:
796
797 - .if <condition>
798 - .elif <condition>
799 - .else
800 - .endif
801
802The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
803as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
804matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
805there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
806only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
807".elif" of a block.
808
809Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
810ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
811as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
812
813The conditions are currently limited to:
814
815 - an empty string, always returns "false"
816 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
817 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200818 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
819
820The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
821
822 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
823 exists, regardless of its contents
824
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200825 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
826 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
827 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
828
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200829 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
830 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
831
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200832 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
833 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
834 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
835 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
836
837 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
838 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
839 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
840 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
841
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200842Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200844 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
845 listen mwcli_px
846 bind :1111
847 ...
848 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100849
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
851 bind :80
852 .endif
853
854 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200855 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200856 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200857 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200858 .endif
859
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200860 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
861 profiling.memory on
862 .endif
863
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200864Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100865
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200866 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100867 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
868 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
869 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
870
871Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
872"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
873fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
874provide advice to the user.
875
876Example:
877
878 .if "${A}"
879 .if "${B}"
880 .notice "A=1, B=1"
881 .elif "${C}"
882 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
883 .elif "${D}"
884 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
885 .else
886 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
887 .endif
888 .else
889 .notice "A=0"
890 .endif
891
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200892 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
893 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
894
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100895
8962.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200897----------------
898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100899Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100900values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
901otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
902numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
903for every keyword. Supported units are :
904
905 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
906 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
907 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
908 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
909 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
910 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
911
912
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009132.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200914-------------
915
916 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
917 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
918 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
919 global
920 daemon
921 maxconn 256
922
923 defaults
924 mode http
925 timeout connect 5000ms
926 timeout client 50000ms
927 timeout server 50000ms
928
929 frontend http-in
930 bind *:80
931 default_backend servers
932
933 backend servers
934 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
935
936
937 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
938 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
939 global
940 daemon
941 maxconn 256
942
943 defaults
944 mode http
945 timeout connect 5000ms
946 timeout client 50000ms
947 timeout server 50000ms
948
949 listen http-in
950 bind *:80
951 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
952
953
954Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
955
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100956 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200957
958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009593. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200960--------------------
961
962Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
963are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
964of them have command-line equivalents.
965
966The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
967
968 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200969 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200971 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200972 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200974 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200975 - description
976 - deviceatlas-json-file
977 - deviceatlas-log-level
978 - deviceatlas-separator
979 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200980 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900981 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200982 - gid
983 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100984 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200985 - h1-case-adjust
986 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100987 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100988 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100989 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200990 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200991 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200993 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100994 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200995 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100996 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100997 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200998 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200999 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001000 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001001 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001002 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001004 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001005 - presetenv
1006 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - uid
1008 - ulimit-n
1009 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001010 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001011 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001013 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001017 - ssl-default-bind-options
1018 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001020 - ssl-default-server-options
1021 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001022 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001023 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001024 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001025 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001026 - 51degrees-data-file
1027 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001028 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001029 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001030 - wurfl-data-file
1031 - wurfl-information-list
1032 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001033 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001034 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001035
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001036 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001037 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001038 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001040 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001041 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001042 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001043 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001044 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001045 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001046 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001047 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001048 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 - noepoll
1050 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001051 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001052 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001053 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001054 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001055 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001056 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001057 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001058 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001059 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001060 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001061 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - tune.buffers.limit
1063 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001064 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001065 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001066 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001067 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001068 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001069 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001070 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001071 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001072 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001073 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001074 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001075 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001076 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001077 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001078 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1079 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001080 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001081 - tune.maxaccept
1082 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001083 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001084 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001085 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001086 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1087 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001088 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1089 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001090 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001091 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001092 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001093 - tune.sndbuf.client
1094 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001095 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001096 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001097 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001098 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001099 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001100 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001101 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001102 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001103 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001104 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001105 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1107 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001108 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1109 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001110
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001113 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001114
1115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011163.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117------------------------------------
1118
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001119ca-base <dir>
1120 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001121 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1122 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1123 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001124
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125chroot <jail dir>
1126 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1127 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1128 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1129 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1130 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001131 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001132
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001133cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1134 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1135 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1136 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1137 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1138 set. These sets have the format
1139
1140 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1141
1142 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001143 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001144 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1145 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001146 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1147 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001148 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1149 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1150 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1151 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1152 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1153 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1154 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1155 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1156 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1157 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001158
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001159 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1160 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1161 on the machine's word size.
1162
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001163 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001164 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1165 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1166 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1167 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1168 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1169 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001170
1171 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001172 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1173
1174 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1175 # first 4 CPUs
1176
1177 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1178 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1179 # word size.
1180
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001181 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001182 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001183 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1185 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1186
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001187 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1188 # and so on.
1189 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1190 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1191 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001193 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001194 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1195 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1196 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1197
1198 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1199 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1200 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1201
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001202 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1203 # and a thread range.
1204 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1205 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1206 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1207
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001208crt-base <dir>
1209 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001210 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1211 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001212
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001213daemon
1214 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1215 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001216 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1217 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001218
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001219default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001220 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001221 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1222 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1223 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1224 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1225 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1226 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1227 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1228 not start with a slash ('/'):
1229 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1230 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1231
1232 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1233 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1234 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1235 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1236 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1237 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1238 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1239 each of them.
1240
1241 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1242 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1243 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1244 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1245 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1246 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1247 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1248 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1249
1250 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1251 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001252 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001253 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1254 made easily relocatable.
1255
1256 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1257 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1258 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1259 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1260 consistent across all configuration files.
1261
1262 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1263 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1264 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1265 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1266 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1267 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1268 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1269 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1270
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001271deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1272 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001273 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001274
1275deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001276 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001277 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1278
1279deviceatlas-separator <char>
1280 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1281 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1282
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001283deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001284 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1285 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1286 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001287
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001288expose-experimental-directives
1289 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1290 the config file will be rejected.
1291
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001292external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001293 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1294 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001295 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1296 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1297 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1298 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1299 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001301gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001302 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001303 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1304 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001305 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001306 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001307 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001308
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001309group <group name>
1310 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1311 See also "gid" and "user".
1312
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001313hard-stop-after <time>
1314 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1315
1316 Arguments :
1317 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1318 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1319 SIGUSR1 signal.
1320
1321 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1322 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1323 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1324
1325 Example:
1326 global
1327 hard-stop-after 30s
1328
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001329h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1330 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1331 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1332 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1333 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001334 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001335 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1336 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1337 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1338 specified in a proxy.
1339
1340 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1341 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1342 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1343 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1344 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1345 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1346 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1347
1348 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1349 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1350 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1351 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1352 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1353
1354 Example:
1355 global
1356 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1357
1358 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1359 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1360
1361h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1362 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1363 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1364 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1365 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1366 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1367 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1368 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1369 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1370
1371 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1372 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1373 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1374
1375 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1376 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1377
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001378insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001379 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001380 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1381 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1382 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1383 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1384 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1385 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1386 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001387 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001388 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1389 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1390 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1391 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1392 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1393 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1394 disable it.
1395
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001396insecure-setuid-wanted
1397 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1398 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1399 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1400 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001401 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001402 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001403 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001404 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1405 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001406 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001407 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1408 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1409 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1410 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1411
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001412issuers-chain-path <dir>
1413 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1414 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1415 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001416 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001417 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1418 "issuers-chain-path".
1419 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1420 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1421 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1422 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1423 will share the chain in memory.
1424
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001425h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1426 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1427 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1428 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1429 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1430 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1431 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1432 the keyword with "no'.
1433
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001434localpeer <name>
1435 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1436 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1437 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1438 the configuration parsing.
1439
1440 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1441 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1442
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001443log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001444 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001445 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001446 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001447 configured with "log global".
1448
1449 <address> can be one of:
1450
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001451 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001452 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1453 port).
1454
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001455 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1456 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1457 port).
1458
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001459 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001460 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1461 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001462 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001463
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001464 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1465 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1466 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1467 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1468 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1469 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1470 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1471 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1472 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1473 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001474 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001475 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1476 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1477 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001478 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1479 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001480
1481 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1482 "fd@2", see above.
1483
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001484 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1485 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1486 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1487 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1488 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1489
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001490 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1491 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001492
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001493 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1494 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1495 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1496 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1497 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1498 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1499 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1500 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1501 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1502 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001503 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1504 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001505
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001506 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1507 one of the following :
1508
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001509 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1510 field is stripped. This is the default.
1511 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1512 rfc3164.
1513
1514 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001515 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1516
1517 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1518 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1519
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001520 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1521 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1522 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1523 designed to be used with a local log server.
1524
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001525 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1526 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1527 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1528 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1529 logger consumes.
1530
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001531 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1532 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1533 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1534 used with a local log server.
1535
1536 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1537 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1538 designed to be used with a local log server.
1539
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001540 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1541 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1542 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1543 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1544
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001545 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1546 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1547 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1548 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1549 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1550
1551 <sample_size>
1552 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1553 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1554 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1555 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1556 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1557
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001558 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001560 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1561 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1562 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1563
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001564 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1565 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1566 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1567 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001568
1569 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001570 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1571 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1572 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1573 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1574 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1575 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001576
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001577 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001578
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001579log-send-hostname [<string>]
1580 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1581 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1582 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1583 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1584 the logs.
1585
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001586log-tag <string>
1587 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1588 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1589 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001590 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001591
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001592lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001593 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1594 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1595 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1596 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1597 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1598 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001599 used multiple times.
1600
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001601lua-load-per-thread <file>
1602 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1603 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1604 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1605 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1606 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1607 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1608 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1609 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1610 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1611 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1612 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1613 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1614 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1615 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1616 times.
1617
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001618lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1619 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1620 variable.
1621 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1622 to "path".
1623
1624 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1625 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1626 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1627 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1628 will be checked earlier.
1629
1630 As an example by specifying the following path:
1631
1632 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1633 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1634
1635 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1636 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1637 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1638 paths if that does not exist either.
1639
1640 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1641 documentation.
1642
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001643master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001644 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1645 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1646 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001647 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001648 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1649 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001650 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1651 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1652 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1653 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1654 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001655
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001656 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001657
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001658mworker-max-reloads <number>
1659 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001660 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001661 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1662 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1663 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1664
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001665nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1667 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1668 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001669 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1670 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001671 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1672 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1673 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001674
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001675nbthread <number>
1676 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001677 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001678 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1679 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1680 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1681 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001682 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1683 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1684 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1685 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1686 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1687 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1688 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001689
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001690numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001691 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001692 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1693 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1694 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1695 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1696 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1697 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1698 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1699 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001702 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1703 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1704 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1705 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001706
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001707pp2-never-send-local
1708 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1709 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1710 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1711 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1712 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1713 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1714 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1715 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1716 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1717 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1718 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1719
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001720presetenv <name> <value>
1721 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1722 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1723 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1724 and "unsetenv".
1725
1726resetenv [<name> ...]
1727 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1728 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1729 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1730 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1731 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1732 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1733 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1734 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1735
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001736stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001737 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1738 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1739 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1740 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1741 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1742 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001743 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001744 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1745 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1746 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1747 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001748
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001749server-state-base <directory>
1750 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001751 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1752 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001753
1754server-state-file <file>
1755 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1756 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1757 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1758 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1759 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1760 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1761 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1762 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001763 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1764 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001765
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001766set-var <var-name> <expr>
1767 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1768 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1769 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1770 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1771 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1772 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1773 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1774 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1775 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1776
1777 Example:
1778 global
1779 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1780 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1781 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1782
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001783setenv <name> <value>
1784 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1785 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1786 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1787 and "unsetenv".
1788
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001789set-dumpable
1790 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001791 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1792 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1793 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1794 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1795 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1796 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1797 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1798 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1799 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1800 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1801 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1802 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1803 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1804 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1805 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001806 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001807 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001808
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001809ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1811 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001812 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001813 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001814 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1815 information and recommendations see e.g.
1816 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1817 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1818 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1819 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001820
1821ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1823 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1824 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1825 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1826 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001827 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1828 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1829 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001830 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001831
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001832ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1834 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1835 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1836 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1837 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1838
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001839ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1841 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1842 keyword to see available options.
1843
1844 Example:
1845 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001846 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001847
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001848ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1850 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001851 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001852 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001853 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1854 information and recommendations see e.g.
1855 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1856 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1857 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1858 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1859 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001860
1861ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1863 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1864 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1865 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1866 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001867 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1868 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1869 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1870 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001871
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001872ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1874 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1875 keyword to see available options.
1876
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001877ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1879 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1880 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001881 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001882 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001883 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1884 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1885 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1886 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001887 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1888 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1889 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1890
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001891ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1892 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1893 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001894 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001895 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001896 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1897
1898 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001899
1900 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1901 and won't try to remove them.
1902
1903 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1904
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001905ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001906 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001907 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1908 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1909 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001910
1911 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1912 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1913 optimize the startup time.
1914
1915 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1916 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1917 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1918
1919 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001920 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001921
1922 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001923 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1924 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001925
1926 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1927 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1928 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1929 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1930 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001931 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001932
1933 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001934 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001935 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1936 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1937 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1938 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1939 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001940 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001941
1942 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1943
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001944 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001945 a cert bundle.
1946
1947 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1948 separately in several "crt".
1949
1950 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1951 since files are loading separately.
1952
1953 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1954 required to commit them.
1955
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001956 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001957 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001958
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001959 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1960 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1961 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001962
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001963 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1964 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1965 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001966
1967 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001968 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1969 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001970
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001971 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1972 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1973
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001974 The default behavior is "all".
1975
1976 Example:
1977 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1978 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1979 ssl-load-extra-files none
1980
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001981 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1982 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001983
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001984ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1985 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1986 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1987 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1988
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001989ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001990 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001991 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1992 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1993 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1994 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1995 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1996 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001997 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001998
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001999stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2000 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2001 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2002 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002003 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002004 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002005
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002006 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2007 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2008 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002009
2010stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2011 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2012 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002013 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002014
2015stats maxconn <connections>
2016 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2017 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002019uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002020 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002021 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2022 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2023 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2024
2025ulimit-n <number>
2026 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2027 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2028 option.
2029
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002030unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2031 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2032
2033 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2034 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2035 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2036 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2037 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002038 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002039 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2040 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2041 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2042 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2043
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002044unsetenv [<name> ...]
2045 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2046 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2047 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2048 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2049 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2050 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2051 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2052
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002053user <user name>
2054 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2055 See also "uid" and "group".
2056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002057node <name>
2058 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2059
2060 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2061 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2062 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2063 traffic.
2064
2065description <text>
2066 Add a text that describes the instance.
2067
2068 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2069 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2070 "<" and ">" characters.
2071
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100207251degrees-data-file <file path>
2073 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002074 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002075
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002076 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002077 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2078
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002080 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2081 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2082 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2083
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002084 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002085 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2086
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200208751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002088 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2089 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2090
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002091 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002092 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2093
209451degrees-cache-size <number>
2095 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2096 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2097 By default, this cache is disabled.
2098
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002099 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002100 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2101
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002102wurfl-data-file <file path>
2103 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2104 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2105
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002106 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002107 with USE_WURFL=1.
2108
2109wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2110 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2111 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2112 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2113
2114 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2115
2116 Valid WURFL properties are:
2117 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2118
2119 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2120 device.
2121
2122 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2123 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2124
2125 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2126 particular web request.
2127
2128 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2129 used Libwurfl API version.
2130
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002131 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2132 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2133
2134 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2135 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2136
2137 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2138
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002139 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002140 with USE_WURFL=1.
2141
2142wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2143 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2144 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002146 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002147 with USE_WURFL=1.
2148
2149wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2150 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2151 thus before the chroot.
2152
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002153 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002154 with USE_WURFL=1.
2155
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002156wurfl-cache-size <size>
2157 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2158 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002159 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002160 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002161
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002162 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002163 with USE_WURFL=1.
2164
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002165strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002166 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002167 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2168 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002169 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002170 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021723.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002173-----------------------
2174
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002175busy-polling
2176 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2177 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2178 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2179 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2180 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2181 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2182 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2183 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2184 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2185 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2186 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2187 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2188 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2189 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2190 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2191 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2192 "poll" pollers.
2193
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002194 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2195 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2196 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2197
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002198max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002199 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002200 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2201 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2202 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2203 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2204 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2205 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2206 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2207
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002208maxconn <number>
2209 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2210 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2211 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002212 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2213 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2214 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2215 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002216 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2217 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2218 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2219 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2220 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2221 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002222
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002223maxconnrate <number>
2224 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2225 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2226 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2227 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2228 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2229 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2230 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2231 fairness.
2232
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002233maxcomprate <number>
2234 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002235 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002236 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2237 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2238 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002239 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002240 default value.
2241
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002242maxcompcpuusage <number>
2243 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2244 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2245 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002246 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002247 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2248 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2249 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2250 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2251
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002252maxpipes <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2254 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2255 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2256 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2257 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2258 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2259
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002260maxsessrate <number>
2261 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2262 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2263 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2264 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2265 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2266 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2267 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2268 fairness.
2269
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002270maxsslconn <number>
2271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2272 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2273 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2274 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2275 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2276 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2277 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002278 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2279 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2280 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2281 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2284 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002285
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002286maxsslrate <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2288 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2289 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2290 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2291 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2292 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2293 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2294 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2295 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2296 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2297
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002298maxzlibmem <number>
2299 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2300 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2301 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002302 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2303 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2304 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2305
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002306no-memory-trimming
2307 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2308 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2309 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2310 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2311 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2312 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2313 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2314 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2315 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2316 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2317 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2318 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2319 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2320 not suffer from such a problem.
2321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322noepoll
2323 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2324 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002325 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326
2327nokqueue
2328 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2329 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2330 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2331
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002332noevports
2333 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2334 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2335 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2336 also "nopoll".
2337
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002338nopoll
2339 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2340 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002342 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2343 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002344
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002345nosplice
2346 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002347 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002348 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002349 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002350 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2351 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2352 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2353 "option splice-response".
2354
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002355nogetaddrinfo
2356 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2357 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2358
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002359noreuseport
2360 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2361 command line argument "-dR".
2362
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002363profiling.memory { on | off }
2364 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2365 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2366 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2367 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2368 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2369 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2370 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2371 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2372 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2373
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002374profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2375 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2376 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2377 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2378 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002379 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002380 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2381 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2382 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2383 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2384
2385 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2386 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2387 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2388 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2389 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002390 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2391 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2392 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2393 CLI.
2394
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002395spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002396 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2397 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2398 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2399 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2400 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2401 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002404 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002406 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2409 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2410 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2412 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2414 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2415 openssl configuration file uses:
2416 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2417
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002418ssl-mode-async
2419 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002420 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002421 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2422 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002424 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002426
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002427tune.buffers.limit <number>
2428 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2429 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2430 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2431 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2432 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002434 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2435 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2436 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2437 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2438 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2439 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2440 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2441 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002442 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002443
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002444tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2445 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2446 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2447 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002450tune.bufsize <number>
2451 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2452 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2453 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2454 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2455 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2456 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2457 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002458 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2459 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002461 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002463 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2464 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002465
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002466tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2467 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002468
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002469tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2470 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2471 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2472 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2473 this value. The default value is 1.
2474
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002475tune.fail-alloc
2476 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2477 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2478 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2479 gracefully.
2480
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002481tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2482 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2483 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2484 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2485 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2486 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2487
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002488tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2489 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2490 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2491 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2492 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2493 change it.
2494
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002495tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2496 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002497 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2500 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2501 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2502 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2503 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2504
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002505tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2507 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2508 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2509 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2510 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002511 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002512 recommended not to change this value.
2513
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002514tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002516 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2519 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2520 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2521 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002523tune.http.cookielen <number>
2524 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2525 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2526 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2527 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2528 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2529 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2530 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2531 to change this value.
2532
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002533tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2535 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002536 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538 configuration directives too.
2539 The default value is 1024.
2540
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002541tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2542 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2543 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2544 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2545 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2546 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2547 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002548 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2549 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2550 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002551
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002552tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2553 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2554 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2555 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2556 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2557 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2558 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002559 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2560 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2561 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2562 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2563 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002564
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002565tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002566 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002567 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2568 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2569 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2570 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002573 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002574 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2575
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002576tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2577 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2578 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2579 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2580 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2581 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2582 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2583 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2584 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2585 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002587tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2588 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002589 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002590 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2591 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002593 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2594 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2595
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002596tune.lua.maxmem
2597 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2598 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2599 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2600 memory.
2601
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002602tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2603 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002604 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2605 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607
2608tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2609 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2610 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2611 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2612 check servers.
2613
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002614tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2615 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2616 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2617 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002618 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002619
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002620tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002621 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2622 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002623 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2624 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2625 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2626 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2627 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2628 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2629 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2630 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2631 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002632
2633tune.maxpollevents <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2635 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2636 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2637 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2638 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2639
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002640tune.maxrewrite <number>
2641 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2642 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2643 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2644 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2645 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2646 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2647 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2648 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2649 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2650 bufsize.
2651
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002652tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2653 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2654 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2655 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2656 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2657 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2658 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2659 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2660 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2661 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002662 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2663 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002664 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2665 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2666 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2667 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2668 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2669 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2670 setting this parameter to 0.
2671
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002672tune.pipesize <number>
2673 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2674 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2675 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2676 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2677 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2678 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2679
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002680tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2681 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002683 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2684 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2685 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2686 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002687 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002689tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2690 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002691 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002692 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2693 default is 20.
2694
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002695tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2696tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2697 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2698 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2699 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002700 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002702 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2703 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2704
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002705tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002707 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2708 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2709 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2710 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2711
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002712tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002714 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2715 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2716 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2717 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2718 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2719 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2720 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002721
2722tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002724 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2726 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2727 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2728 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2729 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2730 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2731 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002732
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002733tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2734tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2735 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2736 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2737 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002738 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002739 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002740 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2741 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2742 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2743 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002744 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002746tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002747 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002748 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2749 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2750 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2751 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2752 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2753 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2754 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2755 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2756 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2757 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2758 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002759
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002760tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002761 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002762 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2763 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2764 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2765 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2766 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2767
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002768tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2769 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2770 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2771 performances. This is disabled by default.
2772
2773 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2774 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2775
2776 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2777
2778 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2779
2780 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2781
2782 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2783 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2784 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2785
2786 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2787 converted.
2788
2789 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2790 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2791 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2792 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2793 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2794 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2795 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002796 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2797 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002798
2799 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2800
2801 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2802 only need this line:
2803
2804 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2805
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002806tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2807 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002808 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002809 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2810 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2811 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2812 being used for too long.
2813
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002814tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2815 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2816 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2817 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2818 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2819 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2820 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2821 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2822 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2823 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2824 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002825 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002826 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002827
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002828tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2829 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2830 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2831 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2832 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002833 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002834 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2835 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002836 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2837 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002838
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002839tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2840 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2841 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2842 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2843 1000 entries.
2844
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002845tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2846 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2847 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2848 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002850tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002851tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002852tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2853tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2854tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002855 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2856 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2857 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2858 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2859 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2860 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2861 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2862 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002863
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002864 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2865 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2866 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2867 all available space is consumed.
2868 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2869 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2870 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002871
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002872tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2873 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002874 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002875 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002876 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002877 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2878
2879tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2880 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2881 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002882 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2883 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028853.3. Debugging
2886--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002887
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002888quiet
2889 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2890 line argument "-q".
2891
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002892zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002893 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002894 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2895 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2896 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2897 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2898 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2899
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029013.4. Userlists
2902--------------
2903It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2904http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2905it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2906
2907userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002908 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002909 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2910
2911group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002912 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2914 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2915
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002916user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2917 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002918 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2919 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002920 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2921 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2922 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2923 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002924
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002925 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2926 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2927 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2928 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2929 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2930 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2931 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002932 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002933 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002934
2935 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002936 userlist L1
2937 group G1 users tiger,scott
2938 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002939
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2941 user scott insecure-password elgato
2942 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 userlist L2
2945 group G1
2946 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2949 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2950 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
2952 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002953
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002954
29553.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002956----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002957It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002958several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002959instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2960values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2961automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2962In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2963using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2964tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2965reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2966Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2967that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2968each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002969
2970peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002971 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002972 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2973
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002974bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2975 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2976 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2977
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002978disabled
2979 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2980 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2981 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2982
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002983default-bind [param*]
2984 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2985
2986default-server [param*]
2987 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2988
2989 Arguments:
2990 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2991 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2992 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2993 details.
2994
2995
2996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2997
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002998enabled
2999 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3000 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003001
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003002log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003003 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3004 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3005 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3006 more details.
3007
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003008peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003011 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003012 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003013 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3014 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3015 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003016
3017 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3018 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3019
3020 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003021 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3022 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3023 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003024
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003025 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3026 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003027
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003028 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3029 "server" keyword explanation below).
3030
3031server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003032 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003033 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3034 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3035 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3036 of this "peers" section).
3037 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3038
3039
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003040 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003041 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003042 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003043 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3044 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3045 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046
3047 backend mybackend
3048 mode tcp
3049 balance roundrobin
3050 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3051 stick on src
3052
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003053 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3054 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003056 Example:
3057 peers mypeers
3058 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3059 default-server ssl verify none
3060 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3061 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003062
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003063
3064table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3065 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3066
3067 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3068 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003069 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003070 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3071 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3072 "stick-table" keyword).
3073
3074 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3075 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3076 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3077 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3078 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3079 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3080 of the stick-table name as follows:
3081
3082 peers mypeers
3083 peer A ...
3084 peer B ...
3085 table t1 ...
3086
3087 frontend fe1
3088 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3089
3090 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3091 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3092
3093 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3094 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3095 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3096 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3097 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3098 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3099 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3100
3101 peers mypeers
3102 peer A ...
3103 peer B ...
3104 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3105
3106 backend t1
3107 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3108
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003109 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003110 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3111 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3112
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031133.6. Mailers
3114------------
3115It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3116If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3117in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3118
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003119mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003120 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3121 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3122
3123mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3124 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3125
3126 Example:
3127 mailers mymailers
3128 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3129 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3130
3131 backend mybackend
3132 mode tcp
3133 balance roundrobin
3134
3135 email-alert mailers mymailers
3136 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3137 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3138
3139 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3140 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3141
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003142timeout mail <time>
3143 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3144 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3145 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3146 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3147
3148 Example:
3149 mailers mymailers
3150 timeout mail 20s
3151 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031533.7. Programs
3154-------------
3155In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3156master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3157managed the same way as the workers.
3158
3159During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3160sequence as a worker:
3161
3162 - the master is re-executed
3163 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3164 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3165 instance of the program
3166
3167During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3168
3169program <name>
3170 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3171 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3172 the management guide).
3173
3174command <command> [arguments*]
3175 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3176 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3177 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3178 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3179
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003180user <user name>
3181 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3182 See also "group".
3183
3184group <group name>
3185 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3186 See also "user".
3187
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003188option start-on-reload
3189no option start-on-reload
3190 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3191 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3192 program section.
3193
3194
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031953.8. HTTP-errors
3196----------------
3197
3198It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3199imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3200several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3201
3202http-errors <name>
3203 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3204 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3205
3206errorfile <code> <file>
3207 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3208
3209 Arguments :
3210 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003211 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003212 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003213
3214 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3215 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3216 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3217 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3218 before any chroot is performed.
3219
3220 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3221
3222 Example:
3223 http-errors website-1
3224 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3225 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3226 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3227
3228 http-errors website-2
3229 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3230 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3231 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3232
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032333.9. Rings
3234----------
3235
3236It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3237servers or traces.
3238
3239ring <ringname>
3240 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3241
3242description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003243 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003244 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3245
3246format <format>
3247 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3248
3249 Arguments:
3250 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3251 one of the following :
3252
3253 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3254 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3255 designed to be used with a local log server.
3256
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003257 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3258 field is stripped. This is the default.
3259 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3260 rfc3164.
3261
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003262 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3263 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3264 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3265 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3266 is the default.
3267
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003268 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003269 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3270
3271 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3272 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3273
3274 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3275 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3276 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3277 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3278 logger consumes.
3279
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003280 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3281 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3282 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3283 with a local log server.
3284
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003285 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3286 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3287 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3288 used with a local log server.
3289
3290maxlen <length>
3291 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3292 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3293 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3294
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003295server <name> <address> [param*]
3296 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3297 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3298 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3299 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3300 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3301 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3302 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3303 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3304 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003305 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3306 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003307
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003308size <size>
3309 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3310 set to BUFSIZE.
3311
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003312timeout connect <timeout>
3313 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3314
3315 Arguments :
3316 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3317 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3318 as explained at the top of this document.
3319
3320timeout server <timeout>
3321 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3322
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003328 Example:
3329 global
3330 log ring@myring local7
3331
3332 ring myring
3333 description "My local buffer"
3334 format rfc3164
3335 maxlen 1200
3336 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003337 timeout connect 5s
3338 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003339 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003340
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033413.10. Log forwarding
3342-------------------
3343
3344It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003345HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003346
3347log-forward <name>
3348 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3349
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003350backlog <conns>
3351 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3352 on connections accept.
3353
3354bind <addr> [param*]
3355 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003356 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3357 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3358 syslog protocol over TCP.
3359 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3361
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003362dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003363 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3364 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3365 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3366 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003367 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003368
3369log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003370log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003371 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3372 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3373 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003374 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003375 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3376 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3377 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003378 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003379
3380 Example:
3381 global
3382 log stderr format iso local7
3383
3384 ring myring
3385 description "My local buffer"
3386 format rfc5424
3387 maxlen 1200
3388 size 32764
3389 timeout connect 5s
3390 timeout server 10s
3391 # syslog tcp server
3392 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3393
3394 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003395 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3396 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003397 # all messages on stderr
3398 log global
3399 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3400 log ring@myring local0
3401 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3402 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3403 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3404 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3405 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003406
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003407maxconn <conns>
3408 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3409 10 is the default.
3410
3411timeout client <timeout>
3412 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034144. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003415----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003416
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003417Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003418 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3419 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3420 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3421 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003422
3423A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3424connections.
3425
3426A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3427to forward incoming connections.
3428
3429A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3430parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3431
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003432A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3433ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3434sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3435the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3436explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3437from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3438"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3439for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3440to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3441optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3442are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3443any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3444names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3445that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3446duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3447names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3448
3449Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3450settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3451of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3452profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3453timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3456'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3457case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3458
3459Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3460logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3461proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3462However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3463name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3464
3465Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3466and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003467bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3469modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3470arbitrary criteria.
3471
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003472In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3473a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003474the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003475
3476 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3477 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3478 between responses and new requests.
3479
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003480 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3481 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3482 client-facing connection remains open.
3483
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003484 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3485 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003486
3487The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3488frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3489following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003490weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003491
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003492 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3495 ----+-----+-----+----
3496 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3497 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003498 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3499 ----+-----+-----+----
3500 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003502It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003503only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3504within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003505as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003506content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003507and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3508possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003510There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003511first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003513second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003514protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3515is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3516new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003517to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003518process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3519already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3520HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3521evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3522one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3523
3524There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3525performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3526tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3527preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3528analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3529HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3530header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3531mitigate this drawback.
3532
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003533There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003534method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3535set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3536in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3537is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3538to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3539above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3540to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3541"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3542frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3543frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3544as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3545upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3546on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3547the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3548upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3549frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3550remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3553--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003555The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3556limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3557they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3558limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003559marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003560option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003561and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3562with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3563specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003565
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003566 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3567------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3568acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003569backlog X X X -
3570balance X - X X
3571bind - X X -
3572bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003573capture cookie - X X -
3574capture request header - X X -
3575capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003576clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3577clitcpka-idle X X X -
3578clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003579compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003580cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003581declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582default-server X - X X
3583default_backend X X X -
3584description - X X X
3585disabled X X X X
3586dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003587email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003588email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003589email-alert mailers X X X X
3590email-alert myhostname X X X X
3591email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592enabled X X X X
3593errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003594errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003595errorloc X X X X
3596errorloc302 X X X X
3597-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3598errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003599force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003600filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003601fullconn X - X X
3602grace X X X X
3603hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003604http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003605http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003606http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003607http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003608http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003609http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003610http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003611http-check set-var X - X X
3612http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003613http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003615http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003616http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003617http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003618id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003619ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003620load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003621log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003622log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003623log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003624log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003625max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003626maxconn X X X -
3627mode X X X X
3628monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003629monitor-uri X X X -
3630option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3631option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3632option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3633option allbackups (*) X - X X
3634option checkcache (*) X - X X
3635option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3636option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003637option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003638option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3639option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003640-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3641option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003642option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3643option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003644option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003645option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003646option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003647option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003648option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003649option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3650option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3651option httpchk X - X X
3652option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003653option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003654option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003655option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003656option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003657option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003658option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3659option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3660option logasap (*) X X X -
3661option mysql-check X - X X
3662option nolinger (*) X X X X
3663option originalto X X X X
3664option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003665option pgsql-check X - X X
3666option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003668option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option smtpchk X - X X
3670option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3671option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3672option splice-request (*) X X X X
3673option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003674option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3676option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3677-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003678option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003679option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3680option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3681option tcpka X X X X
3682option tcplog X X X X
3683option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003684option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003685external-check command X - X X
3686external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003687persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3688rate-limit sessions X X X -
3689redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003692retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003694server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003695server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003697srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3698srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3699srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003700stats admin - X X X
3701stats auth X X X X
3702stats enable X X X X
3703stats hide-version X X X X
3704stats http-request - X X X
3705stats realm X X X X
3706stats refresh X X X X
3707stats scope X X X X
3708stats show-desc X X X X
3709stats show-legends X X X X
3710stats show-node X X X X
3711stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003712-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3713stick match - - X X
3714stick on - - X X
3715stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003716stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003717stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003718tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003719tcp-check connect X - X X
3720tcp-check expect X - X X
3721tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003722tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003723tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003724tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003725tcp-check set-var X - X X
3726tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003727tcp-request connection - X X -
3728tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003729tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003730tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003731tcp-response content - - X X
3732tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733timeout check X - X X
3734timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003735timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003736timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003737timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3738timeout http-request X X X X
3739timeout queue X - X X
3740timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003741timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003743timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003745unique-id-format X X X -
3746unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003748use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003749use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3751 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3755---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756
3757This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3758
3759
3760acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3761 Declare or complete an access list.
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 no | yes | yes | yes
3764 Example:
3765 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3766 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3767 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003769 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003770
3771
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003772backlog <conns>
3773 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | yes | yes | no
3776 Arguments :
3777 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3778 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003779 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003780
3781 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3782 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3783 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3784 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3785 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3786 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3787 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3788 backlog parameter.
3789
3790 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3791 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3792 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3793
3794 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3795
3796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003797balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003798balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003799 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | yes | yes
3802 Arguments :
3803 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3804 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3805 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3806 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3807
3808 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3809 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3810 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3811 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003812 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003813 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003814 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3815 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3816 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3817 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3818 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3819 it, so that you don't worry.
3820
3821 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3822 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3823 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3824 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3825 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3826 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3827 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3828 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003829
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003830 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3831 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3832 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3833 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3834 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3835 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3836 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003837 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3838 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3839 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003840
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003841 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003842 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003843 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3844 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003845 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003846 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3847 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3848 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3849 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3850 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003851 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3852 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3853 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3854 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3855 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3856 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3859 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3860 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3861 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3862 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3863 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3864 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3865 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003866 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003867 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003868 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3869 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3870 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003871
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003872 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3873 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3874 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3875 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3876 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3877 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3878 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3879 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3880 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3881 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3882 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3883 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003884
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003885 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003886 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3887 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3888 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3889 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3890 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3891 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3892 URIs start with a leading "/".
3893
3894 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3895 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3896 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3897 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3898
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003899 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3900 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3901 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3902 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3903
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003904 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003905 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3906
3907 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003908 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3909 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003910 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3911 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3912 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3913 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003914 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003915 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3916 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003917
3918 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3919 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3920 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3921 server will receive the request.
3922
3923 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3924 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3925 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3926 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3927 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003928 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3929 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3930 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003932 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3933 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3934 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3935 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3936 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003938 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003939 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3940 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3941 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3942
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003943 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3944 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3945 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3946
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003947 random
3948 random(<draws>)
3949 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003950 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3951 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3952 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3953 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003954 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3955 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3956 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3957 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3958 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3959 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3960 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3961 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3962 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3963 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3964 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3965 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3966 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3967 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3968 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3969 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3970 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3971 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3972 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3973 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003974
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003975 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003976 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003977 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3978 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003979 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003980 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3981 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3982 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003983 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003984 used instead.
3985
3986 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3987 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3988 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003989 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003990
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003991 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3992 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3993 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3994
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003995 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003996 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3997 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003998
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003999 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4000 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4001 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004002
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004003 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004004 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004005 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4006 NTLM relies on.
4007
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008 Examples :
4009 balance roundrobin
4010 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004011 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004012 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4013 balance hdr(host)
4014 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004015
4016 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4017 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004019 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004020 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4021 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4022 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004023 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004024
4025 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4026 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4027 defaults to 16 kB.
4028
4029 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4030 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4031
4032 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4033 Round Robin.
4034
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004035 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004036 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4037 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4038 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4039
4040 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4041
4042 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004043 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004044 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4045 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4046 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004048 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004049
4050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004051bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4052bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4055 no | yes | yes | no
4056 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004057 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4058 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4059 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4060 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004061 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004062 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4063 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4064 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4065 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4066 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4067 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004068 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004069 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4070 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004071 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004072 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4073 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004074 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004075 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4076 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004077 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004078 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4079 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4080 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4081 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4082 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4083 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4084 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004085 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4086 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4087 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004088 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4089 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4090 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4091 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004092 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4093 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4094 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004095
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004096 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4097 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004098 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4099 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4100 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004101 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4102 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4103 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4104 the range.
4105
4106 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4107 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4108 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4109 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4110 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4111 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4112 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004113 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004114 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004115
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004116 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004117 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004118 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4119 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4120 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4121 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4122 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4123 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4124
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004125 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4126 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4127 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4128 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004130 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4131 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4132 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4133 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4134 in a frontend.
4135
4136 Example :
4137 listen http_proxy
4138 bind :80,:443
4139 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004140 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004142 listen http_https_proxy
4143 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004144 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004145
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004146 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4147 bind ipv6@:80
4148 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4149 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4150
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004151 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004152 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004153
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004154 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4155 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4156 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4157 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4158 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4159
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004160 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004161 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004162
4163
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004164bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004165 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4167 yes | yes | yes | yes
4168 Arguments :
4169 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4170 may be used to override a default value.
4171
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004172 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004173 option may be combined with other numbers.
4174
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004175 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4177 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4178 missing from all processes.
4179
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004180 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004181 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004182 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4183 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4184 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4185 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4186 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004187 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004188
4189 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4190 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4191 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4192 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4193 and 'even' instances.
4194
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004195 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4196 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4197 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4198 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004200 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4201 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4202
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004203 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4204 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4205 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4206
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004207 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4208 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4209
4210 Example :
4211 listen app_ip1
4212 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004213 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004214
4215 listen app_ip2
4216 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004217 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218
4219 listen management
4220 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004221 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004222
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004223 listen management
4224 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4225 bind-process 1-4
4226
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004227 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004228
4229
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004230capture cookie <name> len <length>
4231 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4233 no | yes | yes | no
4234 Arguments :
4235 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4236 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4237 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4238 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004239 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004240
4241 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4242 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4243 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4244 right if it exceeds <length>.
4245
4246 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4247 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4248 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4249 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4250
4251 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4252 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4253 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4254
4255 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4256 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4257 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004258 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4259 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4260 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261
4262 Example:
4263 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4264
4265 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004266 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267
4268
4269capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004270 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4272 no | yes | yes | no
4273 Arguments :
4274 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004275 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004276 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4277 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4278 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4279
4280 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4281 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4282 it exceeds <length>.
4283
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004284 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4286 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004287 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4288 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4289 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4290 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004291 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004292 environments to find where the request came from.
4293
4294 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4295 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4296 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4297 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004298
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004299 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4300 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4301 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4302 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4303 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
4305 Example:
4306 capture request header Host len 15
4307 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004308 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004310 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004311 about logging.
4312
4313
4314capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004315 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4317 no | yes | yes | no
4318 Arguments :
4319 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004320 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004321 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4322 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4323 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4324
4325 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4326 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4327 it exceeds <length>.
4328
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004329 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004330 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4331 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4332 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004333 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4334 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4335 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4336 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004337
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004338 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4339 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4340 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4341 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4342 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343
4344 Example:
4345 capture response header Content-length len 9
4346 capture response header Location len 15
4347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004348 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349 about logging.
4350
4351
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004352clitcpka-cnt <count>
4353 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4354 the connection on the client side.
4355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4356 yes | yes | yes | no
4357 Arguments :
4358 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4359
4360 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4361 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004362 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4363 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004364
4365 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4366
4367
4368clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4369 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4370 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4371 client side.
4372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4373 yes | yes | yes | no
4374 Arguments :
4375 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4376 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4377 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4378 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4379
4380 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4381 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004382 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4383 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004384
4385 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4386
4387
4388clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4389 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4391 yes | yes | yes | no
4392 Arguments :
4393 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4394 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4395 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4396 document.
4397
4398 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4399 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004400 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4401 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004402
4403 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4404
4405
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004406compression algo <algorithm> ...
4407compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004408compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004409 Enable HTTP compression.
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | yes
4412 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004413 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4414 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004415 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004416
4417 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004418 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4419 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4420 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004421
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004422 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004423 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004424
4425 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4426 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4427 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4428 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4429 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004430 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004431
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004432 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4433 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4434 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4435 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4436 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4437 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4438 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004439 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004440
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004441 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004443 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004444 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004445 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004446 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004447 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004448
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004449 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004450 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4451 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4453 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4457 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004458 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004459 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4460 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004461
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004462 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004463 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4464 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004465 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004466 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004467 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4468 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4469 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4470 "multipart"
4471 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4472 header
4473 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4474 and later
4475 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4476 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004478
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004479 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004480
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004481 Examples :
4482 compression algo gzip
4483 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004484
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004485
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004486cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004487 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4488 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004489 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493 Arguments :
4494 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4495 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4496 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4497 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4498 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4499 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004500 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4502 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4503
4504 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004505 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004506 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4507 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4508 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4509 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004510 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4511 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004512 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004513 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4514 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004515
4516 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004517 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004518
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004519 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004520 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004521 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004522 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004523 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4524 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4525 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4526 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4527 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4528 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4529 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004530
4531 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4532 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4533 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4534 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4535 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4536 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4537 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4538 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4539 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004540 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004541 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4542 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4543 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004544
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004545 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4546 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4547 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004548 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4549 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4550 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4551 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4553 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4554 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
4556 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4557 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4558 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4559 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4560 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4561 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4562 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4563 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4564 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4565
4566 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4567 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4568 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4569 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4570 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4571 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4572 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4573 persistence cookie in the cache.
4574 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4575
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004576 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4577 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004578 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004579 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4580 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004581 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004582 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4583 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4584 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4585 they logout.
4586
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004587 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004588 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4589 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4590 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004592 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004593 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4594 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4595 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4596 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4597 this attribute.
4598
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004599 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004600 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004601 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4602 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4603 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4604 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4605 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4606 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004607
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004608 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4609 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4610 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4611 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4612 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4613 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4614 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4615 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004616 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004617 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4618 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4619 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4620 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4621 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4622 the site.
4623
4624 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4625 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4626 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4627 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4628 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4629 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4630 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4631 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4632 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4633 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4634 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4635 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4636 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004637 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004638 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4639 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4640
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004641 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4642 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4643 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4644 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4645 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4646 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4647
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004648 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004649 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4650 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4651 repeated.
4652
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004653 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4654 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4655 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4656 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004657
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004658 Examples :
4659 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4660 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4661 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004662 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004663
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004664 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004665
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004666
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004667declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4668 Declares a capture slot.
4669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4670 no | yes | yes | no
4671 Arguments:
4672 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4673
4674 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4675 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4676 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4677 for use in the response.
4678
4679 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004680 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004681 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4682
4683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004684default-server [param*]
4685 Change default options for a server in a backend
4686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4687 yes | no | yes | yes
4688 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004689 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4690 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4691 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4692 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004693
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004694 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4696
4697 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004698
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004699
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004700default_backend <backend>
4701 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4703 yes | yes | yes | no
4704 Arguments :
4705 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4706
4707 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4708 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4709 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4710 will catch all undetermined requests.
4711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712 Example :
4713
4714 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4715 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4716 default_backend dynamic
4717
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004718 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004720
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004721description <string>
4722 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4724 no | yes | yes | yes
4725 Arguments : string
4726
4727 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4728 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4729 it describes.
4730 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4731
4732
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004733disabled
4734 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4736 yes | yes | yes | yes
4737 Arguments : none
4738
4739 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4740 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4741 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4742 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4743 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4744 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4745 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4746
4747 See also : "enabled"
4748
4749
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004750dispatch <address>:<port>
4751 Set a default server address
4752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004755
4756 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4757 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4758 during start-up.
4759
4760 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4761 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4762 possible with normal servers.
4763
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004764 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004765 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4766 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4767 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4768 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4769
4770 See also : "server"
4771
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004772
4773dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4774 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4776 yes | no | yes | yes
4777 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4778
4779 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004780 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004781 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4782 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004783 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004784 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004786enabled
4787 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4789 yes | yes | yes | yes
4790 Arguments : none
4791
4792 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4793 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4794
4795 See also : "disabled"
4796
4797
4798errorfile <code> <file>
4799 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4801 yes | yes | yes | yes
4802 Arguments :
4803 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004804 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004805 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004806
4807 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004808 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004809 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004810 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4811 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
4813 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4814 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4815 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4816
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004817 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4818
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004819 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4820 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4821 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4822 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4823 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4824 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4825 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4826 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4827 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004828
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004829 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4830 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4831 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004832 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004833 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4834
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004835 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004836
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004837 Example :
4838 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004839 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004840 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4841 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4842
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004843
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004844errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4845 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4846 section.
4847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4848 yes | yes | yes | yes
4849 Arguments :
4850 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4851
4852 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004853 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004854 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4855 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004856
4857 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4858 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4859 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4860 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4861 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004862 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004863 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4864
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004865 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4866 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Example :
4869 errorfiles generic
4870 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4871
4872
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004873errorloc <code> <url>
4874errorloc302 <code> <url>
4875 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 yes | yes | yes | yes
4878 Arguments :
4879 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004880 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004881 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004882
4883 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4884 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4885 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4886 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004887 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888
4889 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4890 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4891 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4892
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004893 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4894
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004895 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4896 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4897 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4898 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004899 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004900 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4901 request.
4902
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004903 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004904
4905
4906errorloc303 <code> <url>
4907 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | yes
4910 Arguments :
4911 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004912 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004913 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914
4915 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4916 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4917 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4918 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004919 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4922 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4923 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4924
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004925 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004927 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4928 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4929 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4930 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004931 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004933 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004934
4935
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004936email-alert from <emailaddr>
4937 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004938 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004939 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4940 yes | yes | yes | yes
4941
4942 Arguments :
4943
4944 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4945
4946 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4947 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4948
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004949 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004950 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4951 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004952
4953
4954email-alert level <level>
4955 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4956 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | yes
4959
4960 Arguments :
4961
4962 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4963 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4964 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4965
4966 By default level is alert
4967
4968 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4969 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4970 for the proxy.
4971
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004972 Alerts are sent when :
4973
4974 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4975 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4976 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4977 is notice or lower
4978 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4979 and a health check status update occurs
4980
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004981 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4982 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004983 section 3.6 about mailers.
4984
4985
4986email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4987 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4988 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4989 yes | yes | yes | yes
4990
4991 Arguments :
4992
4993 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4994
4995 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4996 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4997
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004998 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4999 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005000
5001
5002email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5003 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5004 mailers.
5005 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | yes
5007
5008 Arguments :
5009
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005010 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012 By default the systems hostname is used.
5013
5014 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5015 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5016 for the proxy.
5017
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005018 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5019 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005020
5021
5022email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005023 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005024 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027
5028 Arguments :
5029
5030 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5031
5032 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5033 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5034
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005035 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005036 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5037
5038
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005039force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5040 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5041 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005042 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005043
5044 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5045 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5046 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5047 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5048 marked down for maintenance operations.
5049
5050 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5051 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5052 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5053 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5054 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5055 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5056 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5057 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5058 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5059
5060 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5061 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5062 is used.
5063
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005064 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005065 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005066
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005067
5068filter <name> [param*]
5069 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5071 no | yes | yes | yes
5072 Arguments :
5073 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5074 referenced in section 9.
5075
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005076 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005077 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005078 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5079 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005080
5081 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5082 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5083
5084 Example:
5085 listen
5086 bind *:80
5087
5088 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5089 filter compression
5090 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5091
5092 compression algo gzip
5093 compression offload
5094
5095 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5096
5097 See also : section 9.
5098
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005099
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100fullconn <conns>
5101 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5103 yes | no | yes | yes
5104 Arguments :
5105 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5106 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5107
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005108 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005109 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005110 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5112 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5113 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5114 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5115 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005116 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005118 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005119 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005120 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5121 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5122 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005123
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005124 Example :
5125 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5126 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5127 # connections.
5128 backend dynamic
5129 fullconn 10000
5130 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5131 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5132
5133 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5134
5135
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005136grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005137 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005140 Arguments :
5141 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5142 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5143 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5144
5145 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5146 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005147 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5149
5150 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5151 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5152 simplify it.
5153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005154
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005155hash-balance-factor <factor>
5156 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5157 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5158 yes | no | no | yes
5159 Arguments :
5160 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5161 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005162 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005163
5164 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5165 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5166 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5167 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5168 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5169 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5170 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5171
5172 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5173 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5174 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5175 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5176 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5177
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005178 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5179 consistent hashing mechanism.
5180
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005181 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5182
5183
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005184hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005185 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 yes | no | yes | yes
5188 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005189 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5190 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005191
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005192 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5193 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5194 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5195 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5196 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5197 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5198 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5199 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5200 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5201 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5204 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5205 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5206 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5207 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5208 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5209 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5210 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5211 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5212 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5213 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5214 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5215 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005216 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5217 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005218
5219 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5220
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005221 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005222 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5223 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5224 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005225 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5226 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5227 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005228
5229 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5230 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005231 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5232 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5233 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5234 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5235
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005236 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005237 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5238 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5239 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5240 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5241 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5242 parameter.
5243
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005244 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5245 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5246 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5247 used on strings.
5248
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005249 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5250
5251 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5252 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5253 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5254 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5255 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5256 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5257 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5258 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5259 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5260 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5261 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5262 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005263
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005264 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5265 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5266 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005267
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005268 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005269
5270
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005271http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5273 ones).
5274
5275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 no | yes | yes | yes
5277
5278 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5279 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5280 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5281 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5282 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5283 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5284
5285 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5286 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5287 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5288
5289 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5290 below.
5291
5292 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5293 instance.
5294
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005295 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5296 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5297 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5298
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005299 Example:
5300 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5301 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5302 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5303
5304http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5305
5306 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5307 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5308 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5309 example, or to pass some internal information.
5310 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5311 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5312 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5313
5314http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5317 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5318
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005319http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005320
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005321 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5322 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5323 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5324 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5325 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005326
5327http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5328 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5329
5330 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5331
5332 Example:
5333 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5334
5335 # applied to:
5336 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5337
5338 # outputs:
5339 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5340
5341 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5342
5343http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5344 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5345
5346 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5347
5348 Example:
5349 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5350
5351 # applied to:
5352 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5353
5354 # outputs:
5355 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5356
5357http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5358
5359 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5360 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5361 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5362
5363http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5365
5366 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5367 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5368 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5369 fallback.
5370
5371 Example:
5372 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5373 http-response set-status 431
5374 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5375 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5376
5377http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5378
5379 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5380 inline.
5381
5382 Arguments:
5383 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5384 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5385 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5386 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5387 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5388 (request and response)
5389 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5390 processing
5391 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5392 processing
5393 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5394 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5395 and '_'.
5396
5397 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5398 followed by some converters.
5399
5400 Example:
5401 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5402
5403http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5404
5405 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5406 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5407 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5408 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5409 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005410 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005411 processing.
5412
5413 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5414 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005415 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005416 rules evaluation.
5417
5418http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5419
5420 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5421 details about <var-name>.
5422
5423 Example:
5424 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5425
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005426
5427http-check comment <string>
5428 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5429 it fails.
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 yes | no | yes | yes
5432
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005433 Arguments :
5434 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5435 rule fails.
5436
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005437 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5438 user-friendly error reporting.
5439
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005440 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005441 "http-check expect".
5442
5443
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005444http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5445 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005446 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005447 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5449 yes | no | yes | yes
5450
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005451 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5453
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005454 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005455 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005456
5457 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5458 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5459 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5460 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5461
5462 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5463
5464 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5465
5466 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5467
5468 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5469
5470 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5471
5472 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5473 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5474 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5475 is used.
5476
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005477 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5478 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5479 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5480 haproxy -vv.
5481
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005482 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5483
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005484 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5485 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5486 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5487 different ports or with different servers.
5488
5489 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5490 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5491 the port with a "http-check connect".
5492
5493 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5494 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5495 do.
5496
5497 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5498 unset-var or comment rules.
5499
5500 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005501 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5502 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5503 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5504 option httpchk
5505
5506 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005507 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005508 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005510 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005511 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512
5513 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5514
5515 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005516
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005518http-check disable-on-404
5519 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005521 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005522 Arguments : none
5523
5524 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5525 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5526 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5527 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5528 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5529 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5530 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5531 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005532 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5533 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005534 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5535 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5536 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005537
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005538 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005539
5540
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005541http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005542 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5543 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5544 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005545 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005547 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005548
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005549 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005550 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5551
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005552 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5553 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5554 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5555 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5556 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5557 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5558 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5559 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5560 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5561 result is always conclusive.
5562
5563 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5564 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5565 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005566 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5567 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005568 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5569 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005570 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5571 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5572 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005573
5574 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005576 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5577 supported :
5578 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5579 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005580 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5581 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5582 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5583 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5584 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585
5586 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5587 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005588 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5589 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5590 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5591 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005592 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5593
5594 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5595 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5596 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5597 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5598
5599 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5600 informational message reported in logs if an error
5601 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5602 log-format string.
5603
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005604 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005605 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5606 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005607 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5608 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5609 details on the supported keywords.
5610
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005611 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5612 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5613 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5614 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615
5616 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5617 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5618 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5619 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5620 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5621
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005622 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5623 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5624 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5625 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5626 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5627 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5628 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005629
5630 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005631 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005632 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5633 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5634 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5635 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5636
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005637 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5638 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005639 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5640 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5641 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5642 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5643 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5644 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5645 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5646 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005647 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5648 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5649 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5650 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5651 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5652 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5653 insensitive on the header names.
5654
5655 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5656 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5657 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5658 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5659 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5660 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005661
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005662 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005663 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005664 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5665 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5666 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5667 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5668 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005669 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 trace).
5671
5672 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005674 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5675 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5676 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5677 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5678 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005679 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005681 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5682 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5683 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5684 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5685 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5686 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5687
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005688 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005689 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005690 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5691 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5692 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5693 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5694 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5695 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5696
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005697 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5698 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5699 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5700 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5701 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005702
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005703 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5704 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5705
5706 Examples :
5707 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005708 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005709
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005710 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5711 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5712
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005713 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005714 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005715
5716 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005717 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005718
5719 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005720 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005721
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005722 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005723 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005724
5725
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005726http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005727 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5728 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005729 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5730 health checks.
5731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5732 yes | no | yes | yes
5733 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005734 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5735
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005736 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5737 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5738 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5739 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5740 to invent non-standard ones.
5741
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005742 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5743 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5744 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5745 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5746
5747 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5748 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5749 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5750 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005751
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005752 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005753 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005754 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005755 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5756 to add it.
5757
5758 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5759 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5760 to the log-format rules.
5761
5762 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5763 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5764 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005765
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005766 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5767 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5768 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5769 request.
5770
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005771 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5772 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5773 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005774 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5775 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5776 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5777 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005778 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005779
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005780 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005781 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5782 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005783
5784 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5785 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5786 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5787 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5788 configured request authority.
5789
5790 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5791 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005792
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005793 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005794
5795
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005796http-check send-state
5797 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
5800 Arguments : none
5801
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005802 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005803 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005804 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5805 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5806 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807
5808 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5809 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5810 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5811 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5812 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005813 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5814 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5815 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5816
5817 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5818 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5819 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5820
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005821 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5822 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5823 checked in multiple backends.
5824
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005825 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005826 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5827
5828 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5829 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5830 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5831 one fails.
5832
5833 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5834 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5835 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5836
5837 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5838 server's queue.
5839
5840 Example of a header received by the application server :
5841 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5842 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5843
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005844 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5845 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005846
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005847
5848http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005849 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | no | yes | yes
5852
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005853 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005854 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5855 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5858 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5859 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5860 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5861 and '-'.
5862
5863 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5864
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005865 Examples :
5866 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005867
5868
5869http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005870 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005871 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | no | yes | yes
5873
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005874 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005875 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5876 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5877 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5878 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5879 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5880 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5881 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5882 and '-'.
5883
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005884 Examples :
5885 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005887
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005888http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5889 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5890 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5891 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5892 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | yes
5895 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005896 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005897 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005898 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005899 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005900
5901 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5902 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5903 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5904 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5905
5906 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5907 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5908 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5909 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5910
5911 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5912 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5913 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5914 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5915 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5916 chroot is performed.
5917
5918 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5919 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5920 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5921 considered.
5922
5923 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5924 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5925 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5926 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5927 considered as a raw string.
5928
5929 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5930 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5931 "content-type".
5932
5933 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5934 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5935 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5936 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5937 evaluated as a log-format string.
5938
5939 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5940 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5941 argument to "content-type".
5942
5943 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5944 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5945 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5946 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5947
5948 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5949 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5950 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5951 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5952 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5953 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5954 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5955 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5956
5957 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5958 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5959 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5960
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005961 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5962 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5963 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5964 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5965 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5966
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005967 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5968 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5969
5970
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005971http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005972 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5973
5974 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5975 no | yes | yes | yes
5976
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005977 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5978 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5979 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5980 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5981 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005982
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005983 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5984 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005985
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005986 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005987
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005988 Example:
5989 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5990 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5991 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005992
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005993 http-request allow if nagios
5994 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5995 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5996 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005997
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005998 Example:
5999 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6000 acl add path /addacl
6001 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006003 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006004
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006005 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6006 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 Example:
6009 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6010 acl setmap path /setmap
6011 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006012
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006013 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006015 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6016 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006017
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006018 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6019 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006022
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006023 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6024 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6025 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6026 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6027 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6028 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6029 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6030 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6035 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6036 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6037 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6038 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6039 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6040 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6041 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6046 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006047
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6052 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6053 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6054 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6055 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006056
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006057 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6058 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6059 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6060 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6061 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6062 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6063 instead.
6064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006065 Example:
6066 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6067 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006068
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006069http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006070
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006071 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6077 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6078 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6079 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6080 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6081 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6082 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6083 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6084 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006085
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006086 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6087 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6088 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006089 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6090
6091 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6092 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6093 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6094 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006096http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006098 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6099 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6100 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6101 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6102 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6103 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006104
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006105http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006106
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006107 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6108 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6109 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6110 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6111 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6116 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6117 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6118 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6119 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6120 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006121
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006122http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6123http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6124 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6125 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6126 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6127 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006128
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006129 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6130 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6131 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006132 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6134 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6135 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006136 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006137 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006138
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006139http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6140 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6141 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6142 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6143
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006144http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6145
6146 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6147 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6148 pointed by <resolvers>.
6149 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6150 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6151 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6152 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6153 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6154 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6155 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6156 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6157 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6158 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6159 to 0.0.0.0.
6160
6161 Example:
6162 resolvers mydns
6163 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6164 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6165 timeout retry 1s
6166 hold valid 10s
6167 hold nx 3s
6168 hold other 3s
6169 hold obsolete 0s
6170 accepted_payload_size 8192
6171
6172 frontend fe
6173 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6174 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6175 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6176
6177 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6178 # which mean DNS resolution error
6179 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6180
6181 default_backend be
6182
6183 backend b_503
6184 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6185 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6186 # 503 error page to end users
6187
6188 backend be
6189 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6190 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6191 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6192 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6193 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6194
6195 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6196 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6197
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006198http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6199
6200 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6201 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6202 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6203 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006204 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6205 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006206
6207 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6208
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006209http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006210http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006211http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006212http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006213http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006214http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006215http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006216http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6217http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006218
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006219 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6220
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006221 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006222 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6223 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6224 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6225 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006226
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006227 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6228 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6229 the supported backend.
6230
6231 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6232 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6233 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6234 number of segments in the path.
6235
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006236 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6237 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6238 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6239 when improperly combined.
6240
6241 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6242 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6243 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6244 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6245 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6246
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006247 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006248
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006249 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6250
6251 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6252 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6253
6254 Example:
6255 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6256
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006257 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6258
6259 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6260 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6261
6262 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6263 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6264
6265 Example:
6266 - /#foo -> /
6267
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006268 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6269 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006270
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006271 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6272 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6273
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006274 Example:
6275 - /. -> /
6276 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6277 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6278 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6282
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006283 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006284 their preceding segment.
6285
6286 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6287 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6288
6289 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6290 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006291
6292 Example:
6293 - /foo/../ -> /
6294 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6295 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6296 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006297 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006298 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006299 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006300
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006301 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6302 removed as well:
6303
6304 Example:
6305 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6306 - /bar/../../ -> /
6307
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006308 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6309 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006310
6311 Example:
6312 - // -> /
6313 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6314
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006315 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6316 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6317
6318 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6319 ".", "_", and "~".
6320
6321 Example:
6322 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6323 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6324 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6325 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6326
6327 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6328 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6329
6330 Example:
6331 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6332 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6333
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006334 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006335 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006336
6337 Example:
6338 - /%6f -> /%6F
6339 - /%zz -> /%zz
6340
6341 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6342 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6343
6344 Example:
6345 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6346
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006347 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006348 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6349 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6350
6351 Example:
6352 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6353 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6354 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006356http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006357
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006358 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6359 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6360 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6361 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6362 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006364http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006365
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006366 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6367 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6368 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6369 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006371http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006373
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006374 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006375 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6376 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6377 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6378 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6379 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006380
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006381 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6382 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6383 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6384 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6385 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006386
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 Example:
6388 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6389
6390 # applied to:
6391 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6392
6393 # outputs:
6394 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6395
6396 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006397
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006398 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6399
6400 # applied to:
6401 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006402
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006403 # outputs:
6404 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006405
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006406http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6407 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6408
6409 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6410 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006411 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6412 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6413 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006414
6415 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6416 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6417 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6418
6419 Example:
6420 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6421 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6422
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006423 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6424 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6425 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6426 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6427
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006428http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430
6431 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6432 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6433 query-string are replaced.
6434
6435 Example:
6436 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6437 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6438
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006439http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006442 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6443 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6444 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6445 against.
6446
6447 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6448 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6449 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006450
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006451 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6452 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6453 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6454 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6455 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6456 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6457 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6458 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6459 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006460 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6461 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 Example:
6464 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6465 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006466
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006467 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6468 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006469
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006470http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6471 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006472
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006473 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6474 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6475 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6476 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006477
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006478 Example:
6479 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006480
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006481 # applied to:
6482 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006483
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006484 # outputs:
6485 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006486
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006487http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6488 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6489 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006490 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006491 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6492
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006493 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006494 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6495 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006496 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006497 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006498 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499 are followed to create the response :
6500
6501 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6502 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6503 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6504 ignored.
6505
6506 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6507 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006508 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006509 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6510 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511
6512 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6513 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6514 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006515 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006516 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006517
6518 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6519 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6520 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006521 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006522 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006523 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006524
6525 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6526 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6527 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6528 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6529 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6530 as a raw content.
6531
6532 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6533 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6534 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6535 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6536 considered as a raw string.
6537
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006538 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006539 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6540 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6541 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6542
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006543 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6544 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006545 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006546
6547 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6548
6549 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006550 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006551 if { path /ping }
6552
6553 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6554 if { path /favicon.ico }
6555
6556 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6557 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6558 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006560http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6561http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006562
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006563 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6564 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6565 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006566
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006567http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6568 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006569
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006570 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6571 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6572 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6573 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6578 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6579 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6580 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6581 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006582
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006583 Arguments:
6584 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6585 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587 Example:
6588 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6589 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006591 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6592 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006595
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006596 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6597 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6598 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006600 Arguments:
6601 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6602 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006604 Example:
6605 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6606 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6609 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6610 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6615 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6616 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6617 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6618 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 Example:
6621 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6622 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6623 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6624 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6625 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6626 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6627 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6628 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006631http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6634 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6635 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6636 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6637 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006638
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006639http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6640 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006642 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6643 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6644 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6645 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6646 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6647 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6648 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6649 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6650 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006651
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006652http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6655 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6656 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6657 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6658 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6659 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6660 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006662http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6665 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6666 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006670 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6671 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6672 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6673 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6674 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6675 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6676 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6677 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6682 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6683 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6684 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6685 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6686 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688 Example :
6689 # prepend the host name before the path
6690 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006691
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006692http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6693
6694 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6695 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6696 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6697
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006698http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6701 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6702 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6703 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6704 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006706http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6709 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6710 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6711 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6712 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6713 values have higher priority.
6714 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6715 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6716 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6717 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6718 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006722 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6723 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6724 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6725 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6726 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6727 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6728 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006730 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006731
6732 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006733 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6734 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006735
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006736http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6737 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6738 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6739 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006740 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6741 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742
6743 Arguments :
6744 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6745 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006746
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006747 See also "option forwardfor".
6748
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006749 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6751 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6752
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006753 # After the masking this will track connections
6754 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6755 http-request track-sc0 src
6756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006757 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6758 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6759
6760http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6761
6762 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6763 expression.
6764
6765 Arguments:
6766 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6767 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006769 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006770 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6771 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6772
6773 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6774 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6775 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6776
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006777http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006778 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6779
6780 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6781 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6782 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6783 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6784 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6785
6786 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6787 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6788 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6789 results.
6790
6791 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006792 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6793 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006794
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006795http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6796
6797 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6798 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6799 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6800 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6801 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6802 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6803 information from the request.
6804
6805 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6806
6807http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6810 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6811 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6812 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6813 path and the query string.
6814 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6815
6816http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6817
6818 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6819 inline.
6820
6821 Arguments:
6822 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6823 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6824 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6825 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6826 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6827 (request and response)
6828 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6829 processing
6830 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6831 processing
6832 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6833 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6834 and '_'.
6835
6836 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6837 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006838
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006839 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006841
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006842http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6843 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006845 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6846 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6847 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6848 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6849 agent name must be used.
6850
6851 Arguments:
6852 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6853
6854 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6855 configuration.
6856
6857http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6858
6859 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6860 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6861 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6862 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6863 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6864 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6865 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6866 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6867 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6868 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6869 action.
6870 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6871 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6872 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6873 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6874 you fully understand how it works.
6875
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006876http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6877
6878 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6879 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6880 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6881 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6882 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006883 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006884 processing.
6885
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006886 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006887 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6888 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6889 rules evaluation.
6890
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006891http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6892http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6893 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6894 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6895 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6896 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006897
6898 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6899 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6900 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006901 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6902 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6903 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6904 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6905 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6906 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006907 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006908 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6909 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6910 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006911 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006912 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6913 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6914 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6915 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6916 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006917
6918http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6919http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6920http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6921
6922 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6923 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6924 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6925 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006926 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006927 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6928 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6929 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6930 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6931 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6932 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6933 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6934
6935 Arguments :
6936 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6937 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6938 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6939 select which table entry to update the counters.
6940
6941 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6942 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6943 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6944 that table until the session ends.
6945
6946 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6947 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6948 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6949 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6950 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6951 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6952 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6953 useful information.
6954
6955 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6956 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6957 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6958 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6959 checks that make use of it.
6960
6961http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6962
6963 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006964
6965 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006966 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006967
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006968http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6969
6970 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6971 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6972 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6973 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6974 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6975 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6976
6977 Arguments :
6978 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6979
6980 Example:
6981 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6982
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006983http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6984 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6985
6986 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6987 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6988 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6989 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6990 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6991 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6992 http-buffer-request".
6993
6994 Arguments :
6995
6996 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6997 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6998
6999 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007000 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007001 bytes.
7002
7003 Example:
7004 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7005
7006 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007008http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007009
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007010 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7011 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7012 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007013
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007015http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007016 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7017
7018 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | yes | yes | yes
7020
7021 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7022 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7023 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7024 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7025 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7026 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007028 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7029 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033 Example:
7034 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007035
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007036 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7039 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007041 Example:
7042 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007044 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007046 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7047 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007048
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007049 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7050 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007054 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7055 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7056 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7057 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7058 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7059 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7060 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7061 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007063http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007065 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7066 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7067 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7068 example, or to pass some internal information.
7069 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7070 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7071 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007073http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7076 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007078http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007079
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007080 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007083
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007084 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7085 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7086 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7087 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7088 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7089 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7090 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007092 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7093 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7094 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7095 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7096 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007097
7098 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7099 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7100 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7101 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7106 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7107 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7108 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7109 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7110 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007111
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007112http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007113
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007114 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7115 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7116 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7117 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7118 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007119
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007120http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007121
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007122 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7123 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7124 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7125 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7126 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7127 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007128
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007129http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7130http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7131 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7132 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7133 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7134 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007135
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007136 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7137 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7138 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007139 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007140 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7141 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7142 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007143 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007144 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007145
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007146http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007148 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7149 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7150 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7151 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7152 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7153 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007155http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007157
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007158 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7159 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007160
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007161 Example:
7162 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007163
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007164 # applied to:
7165 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167 # outputs:
7168 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007169
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007170 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007172http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7173 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007174
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007175 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007176 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178 Example:
7179 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181 # applied to:
7182 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 # outputs:
7185 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007186
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007187http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7188 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7189 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007190 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007191 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7192
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007193 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007194 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7195 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007196 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007197 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007198 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199 are followed to create the response :
7200
7201 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7202 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7203 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7204 ignored.
7205
7206 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7207 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007208 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007209 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7210 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211
7212 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7213 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7214 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007215 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007216 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007217
7218 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7219 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7220 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007221 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007222 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007223 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7226 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7227 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7228 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7229 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7230 as a raw content.
7231
7232 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7233 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7234 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7235 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7236 considered as a raw string.
7237
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007238 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7239 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7240 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7241 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7242
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007243 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7244 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007245 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007246
7247 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7248
7249 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007250 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251 if { status eq 404 }
7252
7253 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7254 string "This is the end !" \
7255 if { status eq 500 }
7256
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007257http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7258http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007259
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007260 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7261 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7262 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007263
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007264http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7265 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007266
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007267 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7268 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7269 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7270 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007271
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007272http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7273 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007274
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007275 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7276 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7277 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7278 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7279 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007280
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007281 Arguments:
7282 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007284 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7285 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7290 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7291 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7294
7295 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7296 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7297 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7298 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7299 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7300
7301http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7302
7303 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7304 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7305 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7306 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7307 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7308 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7309 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7310 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7311 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7312
7313http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7314
7315 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7316 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7317 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7318 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7319 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7320 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7321 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7322
7323http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7324
7325 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7326 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7327 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7328 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7329 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7330 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7331 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7332 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7333
7334http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7335 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7336
7337 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7338 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7339 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7340 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007341
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007342 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007343 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7344 http-response set-status 431
7345 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7346 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007347
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007349
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7351 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7352 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7353 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7354 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7355 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7356 based on some information from the request.
7357
7358 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7359
7360http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7361
7362 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7363 inline.
7364
7365 Arguments:
7366 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7367 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7368 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7369 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7370 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7371 (request and response)
7372 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7373 processing
7374 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7375 processing
7376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7377 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7378 and '_'.
7379
7380 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7381 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007382
7383 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007385
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007386http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007387
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007388 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7389 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7390 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7391 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7392 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7393 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7394 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7395 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7396 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7397 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7398 action.
7399 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7400 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7401 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7402 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7403 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007404
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007405http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7406
7407 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7408 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7409 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7410 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7411 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007412 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007413 processing.
7414
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007415 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007416 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007417 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007418 rules evaluation.
7419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7421http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7422http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007423
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007424 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7425 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7426 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7427 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7428 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007429 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007430
7431http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7432
7433 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7434 about <var-name>.
7435
7436 Example:
7437 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7438
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007439http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7441
7442 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7443 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7444 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7445 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7446 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7447 buffer is full.
7448
7449 Arguments :
7450
7451 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7452 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7453
7454 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007455 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007456 bytes.
7457
7458 Example:
7459 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007460
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007461http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7462 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7463
7464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7465 yes | no | yes | yes
7466
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007467 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007468 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7469 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7470 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007471
7472 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7473
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007474 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7475 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7476 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7477 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7478 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7479 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7480 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007481 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007482 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7483 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007484
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007485 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7486 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7487 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7488 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7489 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7490 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7491 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007492 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7493 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7494 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7495 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7496 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7497 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007498
7499 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7500 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7501 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7502 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7503 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7504 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7505 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7506 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007507 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007508 downsides of rare connection failures.
7509
7510 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7511 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7512 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7513 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7514 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7515 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007517 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7518 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7519 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7520 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7521 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7522
7523 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007524 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7525 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7526 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7527 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007528
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007529 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7530 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007531
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007532 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007533
7534 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7535 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7536 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7537
7538 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7539
7540
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007541http-send-name-header [<header>]
7542 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007546 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7547
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007548 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7549 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7550 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7551 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7552 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7553 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7554 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7555 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7556 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7557 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7558 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7559 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7560 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7561 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7562 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7563 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007564
7565 See also : "server"
7566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007567id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007568 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 no | yes | yes | yes
7571 Arguments : none
7572
7573 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7574 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7575 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007576
7577
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007578ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7579 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007581 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007582
7583 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7584 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7585 and running).
7586
7587 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7588 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7589 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007590 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007591 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7592
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007593 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7594 "unless" condition is met.
7595
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007596 Example:
7597 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7598 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7599 ignore-persist if url_static
7600
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007601 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7602
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007603load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7604 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607
7608 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7609 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7610 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007612 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007613 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7614 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7615 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007619 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620
7621 Arguments:
7622 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7623 named "server-state-file".
7624
7625 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7626 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7627 name is used as a file name.
7628
7629 none don't load any stat for this backend
7630
7631 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007632 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7633 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7634 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007636 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007637
7638 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7639 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7640
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007641 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007642
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007643 global
7644 stats socket /tmp/socket
7645 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007646
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007647 defaults
7648 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007650 backend bk
7651 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7652 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654
7655 Then one can run :
7656
7657 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7658
7659 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7660
7661 1
7662 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7663 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7664 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7665
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007666 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007667
7668 global
7669 stats socket /tmp/socket
7670 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7671
7672 defaults
7673 load-server-state-from-file local
7674
7675 backend bk
7676 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7677 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7678
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007679
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680 Then one can run :
7681
7682 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7683
7684 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7685
7686 1
7687 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7688 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7689 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7690
7691 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7692 "show servers state"
7693
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007695log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007696log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007697 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007698no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007699 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007702
7703 Prefix :
7704 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7705 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7706 prefix does not allow arguments.
7707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007708 Arguments :
7709 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7710 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7711 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7712 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7713 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7714 parameter.
7715
7716 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7717 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7718
7719 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7720 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7721 standard syslog port).
7722
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007723 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7724 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7725 standard syslog port).
7726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007727 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7728 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7729 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007730 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007731
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007732 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7733 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7734 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7735 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7736 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7737 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7738 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7739 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7740 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7741 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7742 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7743 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007744 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007745 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7746 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7747 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007748 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7749 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007750
7751 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7752 and "fd@2", see above.
7753
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007754 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7755 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7756 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7757 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7758 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7759 having the logs instantly available.
7760
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007761 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7762 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7763 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7764
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007765 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7766 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007767
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007768 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7769 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7770 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7771 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7772 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7773 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7774 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7775 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7776 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7777 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007779
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007780 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7781 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7782 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7783 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7784 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7785
7786 <sample_size>
7787 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7788 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7789 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7790 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7791 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7792
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007793 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7794 one of the following :
7795
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007796 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7797 field is stripped. This is the default.
7798 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7799 rfc3164.
7800
7801 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007802 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7803
7804 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7805 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7806
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007807 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7808 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7809 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7810 designed to be used with a local log server.
7811
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007812 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7813 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7814 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7815 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7816 systemd logger consumes.
7817
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007818 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7819 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7820 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7821 used with a local log server.
7822
7823 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7824 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7825 designed to be used with a local log server.
7826
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007827 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7828 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7829 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7830 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007832 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7833
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007834 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7835 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7836 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7837
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007838 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7839 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7840 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7841 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007842
7843 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7844 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7845 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007846 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7847 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7848 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7849 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7850 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007851
7852 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7853
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007854 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7855 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7856 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007857
7858 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7859 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7860 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7861 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7862
7863 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7864 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007865
7866 Example :
7867 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007868 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7869 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7870 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007871 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007872 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7873 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007874 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007877log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007878 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007881
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007882 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7883 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7884 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7885 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7886 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007887
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007888 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7889 "option httplog" directives.
7890
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007891log-format-sd <string>
7892 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | yes | yes | no
7895
7896 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7897 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7898 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7899 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7900 which covers the log format string in depth.
7901
7902 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7903 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7904
7905 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7906 log format to "rfc5424".
7907
7908 Example :
7909 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7910
7911
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007912log-tag <string>
7913 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7915 yes | yes | yes | yes
7916
7917 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7918 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007919 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007920 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7921 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7922 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7923 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7924 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7925 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007926
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007927max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7928 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7930 yes | no | yes | yes
7931
7932 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7933 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7934 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7935 servers.
7936
7937 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007938 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007939 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7940 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7941 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007943 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7944 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7945 picking a different server.
7946
7947 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7948 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7949 even if they have to be queued.
7950
7951 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7952 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7953
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007954max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7955 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7956 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7957 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007959maxconn <conns>
7960 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7962 yes | yes | yes | no
7963 Arguments :
7964 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7965 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7966 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7967 closes.
7968
7969 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007970 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007971 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7972 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007973 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7974 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7975 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7976 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007977
7978 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7979 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7980 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7981
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007982 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7983 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7986
7987
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007988mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007989 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7991 yes | yes | yes | yes
7992 Arguments :
7993 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7994 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7995 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7996 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7997
7998 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7999 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8000 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8001 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8002 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8003
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008004 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8005 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8006 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008007
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008008 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009 defaults http_instances
8010 mode http
8011
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008012
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008013monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8016 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017 Arguments :
8018 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8019 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008020 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008021 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8022 backend and its backup.
8023
8024 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8025 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8026 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8027 servers in a list of backends.
8028
8029 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8030 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8031 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008032 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008033 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8034 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008035 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008036 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8037 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008038
8039 Example:
8040 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008041 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008042 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8043 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8044 monitor-uri /site_alive
8045 monitor fail if site_dead
8046
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008047 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048
8049
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050monitor-uri <uri>
8051 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8053 yes | yes | yes | no
8054 Arguments :
8055 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8056 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8057
8058 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8059 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8060 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8061 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8062 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8063 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8064 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8065 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8066
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008067 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008068 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8069 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8070 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8071 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8072 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8073 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008074
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008075 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8076 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8077 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8078 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8079
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008080 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008081 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008082 frontend www
8083 mode http
8084 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8085
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008086 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008088
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008089option abortonclose
8090no option abortonclose
8091 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8093 yes | no | yes | yes
8094 Arguments : none
8095
8096 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8097 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8098 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8099 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008100 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008101 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8102 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8103 encountered while delivering the response.
8104
8105 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8106 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8107 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8108 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8109 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8110 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008111 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008112 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008113 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008114 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8115 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8116 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8117
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008118 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8119 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008120 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8121 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8122 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8123 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8124 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8125 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008126 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008127
8128 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8129 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8130
8131 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8132
8133
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008134option accept-invalid-http-request
8135no option accept-invalid-http-request
8136 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | yes | yes | no
8139 Arguments : none
8140
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008141 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008142 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008143 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008144 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8145 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8146 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8147 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8148 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008149 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8150 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8151 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8152 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008153 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008154 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008155 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8156 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8157 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008158
8159 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8160 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8161 been confirmed.
8162
8163 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8164 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008165 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8166 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008167 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8168
8169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8171
8172 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8173 stats socket.
8174
8175
8176option accept-invalid-http-response
8177no option accept-invalid-http-response
8178 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8180 yes | no | yes | yes
8181 Arguments : none
8182
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008183 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008184 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008185 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008186 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8187 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8188 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8189 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8190 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008191 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8192 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8193 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008194
8195 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8196 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8197 been confirmed.
8198
8199 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8200 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8201 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8202 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8203
8204 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8205 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8206
8207 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8208 stats socket.
8209
8210
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008211option allbackups
8212no option allbackups
8213 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8214 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8215 yes | no | yes | yes
8216 Arguments : none
8217
8218 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8219 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8220 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8221 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8222 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8223 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8224 order between the backup servers anymore.
8225
8226 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8227 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8228
8229 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8230 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8231
8232
8233option checkcache
8234no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008235 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | no | yes | yes
8238 Arguments : none
8239
8240 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8241 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008242 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008243 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8244 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008245 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008246
8247 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008248 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008249 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008250 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8251 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008252 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008253 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008254 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8255 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008256 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008257 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8258 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008259 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008260 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8261 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8262 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8263 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8264 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8265 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8266 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8268 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8269
8270 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008271 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8272 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8273 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8274 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008275
8276 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8277 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008278 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008279 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008280
8281 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8282 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8283
8284
8285option clitcpka
8286no option clitcpka
8287 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8289 yes | yes | yes | no
8290 Arguments : none
8291
8292 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8293 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008294 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008295 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8296
8297 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8298 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8299 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8300 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8301
8302 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8303 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8304 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8305 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8306 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8307
8308 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8309
8310 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8311 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8312 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8313
8314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8316
8317 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8318
8319
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008320option contstats
8321 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8323 yes | yes | yes | no
8324 Arguments : none
8325
8326 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8327 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8328 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008329 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008330 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8331 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8332 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8333 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8334 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008335
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008336option disable-h2-upgrade
8337no option disable-h2-upgrade
8338 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8339 connection.
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | no
8342 Arguments : none
8343
8344 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8345 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8346 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8347 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008348 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8349 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8350 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8351 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8352 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8353 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008354
8355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008357
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008358option dontlog-normal
8359no option dontlog-normal
8360 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8362 yes | yes | yes | no
8363 Arguments : none
8364
8365 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8366 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8367 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8368 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8369 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8370 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8371 logged.
8372
8373 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8374 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8375 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008377 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008378 logging.
8379
8380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008381option dontlognull
8382no option dontlognull
8383 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8385 yes | yes | yes | no
8386 Arguments : none
8387
8388 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8389 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8390 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8391 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8392 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8393 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008394 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8395 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8396 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008397
8398 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008399 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008400 would not be logged.
8401
8402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8404
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008405 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008406 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008407
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008408
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008409option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008410 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8412 yes | yes | yes | yes
8413 Arguments :
8414 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8415 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008416 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008417 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008418
8419 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8420 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8421 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8422 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8423 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8424 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8425 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008426 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8427 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8428 possible that the client has already brought one.
8429
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008430 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008431 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008432 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008433 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008434 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008435 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008436
8437 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8438 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8439 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8440 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8441 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8442 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008443 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008444
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008445 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8446 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008447 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008448 are under the control of the end-user.
8449
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008451 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8452 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008453 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8454 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8455 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008456
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008457 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8459 frontend www
8460 mode http
8461 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8462
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008463 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8464 backend www
8465 mode http
8466 option forwardfor header X-Client
8467
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008468 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008469 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008470
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008471
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008472option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8473no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8474 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8476 yes | yes | yes | no
8477 Arguments : none
8478
8479 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8480 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8481 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8482 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8483 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8484 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8485 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8486
8487 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8488 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8489 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8490 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8491 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8492 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8493 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8494 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8495 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8496 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8497
8498 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8499
8500 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8501 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8502
8503 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8504 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8505
8506
8507option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8508no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8509 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8511 yes | no | yes | yes
8512 Arguments : none
8513
8514 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8515 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8516 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8517 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8518 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8519 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8520 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8521
8522 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8523 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8524 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8525 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8526 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8527 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8528 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8529 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8530 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8531 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8532
8533 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8534
8535 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8536 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8537
8538 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8539 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8540
8541
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008542option http-buffer-request
8543no option http-buffer-request
8544 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8546 yes | yes | yes | yes
8547 Arguments : none
8548
8549 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8550 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8551 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8552 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8553 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8554 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008555 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8556 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8557 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8558 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008559
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008560 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8561 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008562
8563
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008564option http-ignore-probes
8565no option http-ignore-probes
8566 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8568 yes | yes | yes | no
8569 Arguments : none
8570
8571 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8572 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8573 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8574 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8575 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8576 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8577 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8578 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8579 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008580 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8581 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008582 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8583
8584 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8585 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8586 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8587 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8588 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8589 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8590 are often the only way to detect them.
8591
8592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8594
8595 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8596
8597
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008598option http-keep-alive
8599no option http-keep-alive
8600 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8602 yes | yes | yes | yes
8603 Arguments : none
8604
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008605 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8606 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008607 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8608 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008609 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8610 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8611 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008612
8613 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8614 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008615 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8616 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8617 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8618 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8619 situations where this option may be useful :
8620
8621 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008622 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008623
8624 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8625 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8626
8627 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8628 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8629 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8630 request.
8631
8632 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8633 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008634 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8635 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8636 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008637
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008638 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8639 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8640 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8641 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8642 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8643 not set.
8644
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008645 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8646 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8647 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008648
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008649 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008650 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008651 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008652
8653
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008654option http-no-delay
8655no option http-no-delay
8656 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 yes | yes | yes | yes
8659 Arguments : none
8660
8661 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8662 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8663 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8664 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8665 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8666 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8667 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008668 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008669 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8670 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8671 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8672 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8673 affected.
8674
8675 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8676 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8677 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8678 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8679 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8680 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8681 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8682 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8683 latency environments.
8684
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008685 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8686
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008687
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008688option http-pretend-keepalive
8689no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008690 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008692 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008693 Arguments : none
8694
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008695 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008696 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8697 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8698 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008699 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008700 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8701 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8702 consider the response complete.
8703
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008704 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008706 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008708 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008709 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8710
8711 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8712 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8713 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8714 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008715 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8716 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008717 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8718
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008719 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8720 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8721 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8722 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8723 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8724 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008725
8726 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8727 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8728
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008729 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008730 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008731
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008732
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008733option http-server-close
8734no option http-server-close
8735 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8737 yes | yes | yes | yes
8738 Arguments : none
8739
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008740 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8741 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8742 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8743 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008744 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8745 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8746 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8747 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8748 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8749 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8750 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8751 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8752 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8753 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8754 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008755
8756 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8757 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8758 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8759 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008760 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8761 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008762
8763 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8764 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008765 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8766 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8767 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008768
8769 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8770 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8771
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008772 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8773 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008774
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008775option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008776no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008777 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8779 yes | yes | yes | no
8780 Arguments : none
8781
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008782 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008783 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8784 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8785 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8786 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8787 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008788 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008789
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008790 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008791 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008792 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8793 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8794 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008795
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008796 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8797 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8798 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8799 front of an existing proxy.
8800
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008801 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8802
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008803 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008805option httpchk
8806option httpchk <uri>
8807option httpchk <method> <uri>
8808option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008809 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8811 yes | no | yes | yes
8812 Arguments :
8813 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8814 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8815 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8816 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8817 ones.
8818
8819 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8820 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8821 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8822
8823 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8824 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8825 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008826 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008827
8828 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8829 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8830 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8831 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8832 the lack of any response.
8833
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008834 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8835 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8836 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8837 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8838
8839 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8840 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8841 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008842
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008843 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8844 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008845 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008846 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008847 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008848
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008849 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8850 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8851 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8852 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8853
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008854 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008855 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8856 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8857 backend https_relay
8858 mode tcp
8859 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8860 http-check send hdr Host www
8861 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008862
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008863 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8864 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8865 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008866
8867
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008868option httpclose
8869no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008870 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8872 yes | yes | yes | yes
8873 Arguments : none
8874
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008875 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8876 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8877 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8878 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008879 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008880
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008881 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8882 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008883 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008884 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8885 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008886
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008887 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8888 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8889 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008890
8891 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8892 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008893 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8894 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8895 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008896
8897 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8898 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8899
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008900 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008901
8902
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008903option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008904 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008906 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008907 Arguments :
8908 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8909 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8910 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008911 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008912 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008913
8914 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8915 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8916 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8917 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8918 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8919 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8920 ports.
8921
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008922 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8923 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008924
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008925 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8926
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008927 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008928
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008929
8930option http_proxy
8931no option http_proxy
8932 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8934 yes | yes | yes | yes
8935 Arguments : none
8936
8937 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8938 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8939 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8940 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8941 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8942
8943 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8944 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008945 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8946 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008947
8948 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8949 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8950
8951 Example :
8952 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8953 backend direct_forward
8954 option httpclose
8955 option http_proxy
8956
8957 See also : "option httpclose"
8958
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008959
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008960option independent-streams
8961no option independent-streams
8962 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 yes | yes | yes | yes
8965 Arguments : none
8966
8967 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8968 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8969 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8970 receive data or not.
8971
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008972 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008973 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8974 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8975 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8976 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8977 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8978 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8979 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8980 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8981 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8982 socket buffers.
8983
8984 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8985 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8986 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8987 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8988 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8989
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008990 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008991
8992
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008993option ldap-check
8994 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8996 yes | no | yes | yes
8997 Arguments : none
8998
8999 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9000 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9001 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9002 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9003
9004 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9005 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9006
9007 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9008 configure it.
9009
9010 Example :
9011 option ldap-check
9012
9013 See also : "option httpchk"
9014
9015
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009016option external-check
9017 Use external processes for server health checks
9018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9019 yes | no | yes | yes
9020
9021 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9022 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9023 command".
9024
9025 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9026
9027 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9028
9029
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009030option idle-close-on-response
9031no option idle-close-on-response
9032 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 yes | yes | yes | no
9035 Arguments : none
9036
9037 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9038 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9039 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9040 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9041 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9042 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9043 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9044 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9045 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9046
9047 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9048 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9049
9050 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9051 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9052 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9053 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9054
9055 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9056 "hard-stop-after"
9057
9058
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009059option log-health-checks
9060no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009061 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | no | yes | yes
9064 Arguments : none
9065
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009066 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9067 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9068 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009069
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009070 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9071 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9072 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9073 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9074 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9075
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009076 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009077 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009078
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009079 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9080 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9081 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009082
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009083
9084option log-separate-errors
9085no option log-separate-errors
9086 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9088 yes | yes | yes | no
9089 Arguments : none
9090
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009091 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009092 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9093 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9094 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9095 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9096 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9097 provides very important information.
9098
9099 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9100 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9101 error logs.
9102
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009103 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009104 logging.
9105
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009106
9107option logasap
9108no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009109 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9111 yes | yes | yes | no
9112 Arguments : none
9113
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009114 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9115 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9116 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9117 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9118
9119 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9120 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9121 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9122 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9123 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009124 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009125 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9126 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9127 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9128 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009129 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009131 Examples :
9132 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9133 mode http
9134 option httplog
9135 option logasap
9136 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9137
9138 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9139 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9140 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9141 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009143 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009144 logging.
9145
9146
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009147option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009148 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9150 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009151 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009152 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9153 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009154 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9155 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009156
9157 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9158 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009159 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009160 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009161 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9162 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9163 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009164
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009165 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9166 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9167 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009168
9169 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009170 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009171 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9172 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9173 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9174 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9175 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9176 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9177 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9178
9179 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9180 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009181
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009182 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009183
9184 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9185 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9186 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9187 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009188 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009189 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009190
9191 See also: "option httpchk"
9192
9193
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009194option nolinger
9195no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009196 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9198 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009199 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009200
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009201 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009202 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9203 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9204 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9205 connections.
9206
9207 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9208 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009209 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9210 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9211 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9212 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9213 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9214 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9215 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9216 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9217 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9218 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9219 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9220 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9221 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009222
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009223 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9224 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9225 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9226 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9227 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009228
9229 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9230 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009231 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009232 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009233 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009234
9235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9237
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009238 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9239 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009240
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009241option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9242 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 yes | yes | yes | yes
9245 Arguments :
9246 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9247 matching <network>
9248 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9249 header name.
9250
9251 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9252 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9253 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9254 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9255 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9256 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9257 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9258 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9259 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9260 possible that the client has already brought one.
9261
9262 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9263 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9264 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9265 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9266 header and requires different one.
9267
9268 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9269 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9270 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009271 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9272 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9273 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9274 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9275 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009276
9277 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9278 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9279 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9280 both are defined.
9281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009282 Examples :
9283 # Original Destination address
9284 frontend www
9285 mode http
9286 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9287
9288 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9289 backend www
9290 mode http
9291 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9292
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009293 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009294
9295
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009296option persist
9297no option persist
9298 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9299 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9300 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009301 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009302
9303 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9304 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9305 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9306 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9307 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9308 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9309 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9310 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9311 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9312 redirected to another valid server.
9313
9314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9316
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009317 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009318
9319
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009320option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9321 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9323 yes | no | yes | yes
9324 Arguments :
9325 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9326 PostgreSQL server.
9327
9328 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9329 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9330 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9331 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9332
9333 See also: "option httpchk"
9334
9335
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009336option prefer-last-server
9337no option prefer-last-server
9338 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9339 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9340 yes | no | yes | yes
9341 Arguments : none
9342
9343 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009344 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009345 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9346 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009347 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009348 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009349 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009350 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9351 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009352 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009353 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009354 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9355 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9356 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009357 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9358 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9359 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009360
9361 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9362 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9363
9364 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9365
9366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009367option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009368option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009369no option redispatch
9370 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9371 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9372 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009373 Arguments :
9374 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9375 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9376 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009377 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009378 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009379 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009380 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9381 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9382 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9383
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009384
9385 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9386 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9387 be able to access the service anymore.
9388
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009389 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9390 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009391
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009392 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9393 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9394 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9395 following order:
9396
9397 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9398
9399 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9400 list, or
9401
9402 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9403
9404 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9405 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9406
9407 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9408 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9409 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9410 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9411
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009412 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009413 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9414 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009415
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9418
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009419 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009420
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009421
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009422option redis-check
9423 Use redis health checks for server testing
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9425 yes | no | yes | yes
9426 Arguments : none
9427
9428 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9429 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9430 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9431 find the "+PONG" response message.
9432
9433 Example :
9434 option redis-check
9435
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009436 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009437
9438
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009439option smtpchk
9440option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9441 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9443 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009444 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009445 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009446 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009447 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9448
9449 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9450 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9451 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9452
9453 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9454 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9455 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9456 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9457 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9458 dead server.
9459
9460 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9461 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009462 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009463 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9464
9465 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9466 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9467 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9468 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009469 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009470
9471 Example :
9472 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9473
9474 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009477option socket-stats
9478no option socket-stats
9479
9480 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9482 yes | yes | yes | no
9483
9484 Arguments : none
9485
9486
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009487option splice-auto
9488no option splice-auto
9489 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 yes | yes | yes | yes
9492 Arguments : none
9493
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009494 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009495 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009496 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009497 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009498 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009499 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9500 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9501 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9502 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9503
9504 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9505 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9506 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9507 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9508 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9509 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9510 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9511 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9512 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9513 keyword.
9514
9515 Example :
9516 option splice-auto
9517
9518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9520
9521 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9522 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9523
9524
9525option splice-request
9526no option splice-request
9527 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9529 yes | yes | yes | yes
9530 Arguments : none
9531
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009532 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009533 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009534 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9535 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9536 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9537 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9538
9539 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9540
9541 Example :
9542 option splice-request
9543
9544 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9545 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9546
9547 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9548 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9549
9550
9551option splice-response
9552no option splice-response
9553 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9555 yes | yes | yes | yes
9556 Arguments : none
9557
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009558 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009559 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009560 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9561 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9562 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9563 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9564
9565 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9566
9567 Example :
9568 option splice-response
9569
9570 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9571 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9572
9573 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9574 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9575
9576
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009577option spop-check
9578 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9580 no | no | no | yes
9581 Arguments : none
9582
9583 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9584 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9585 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9586 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9587
9588 Example :
9589 option spop-check
9590
9591 See also : "option httpchk"
9592
9593
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009594option srvtcpka
9595no option srvtcpka
9596 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9598 yes | no | yes | yes
9599 Arguments : none
9600
9601 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9602 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009603 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009604 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9605
9606 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9607 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9608 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9609 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9610
9611 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9612 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9613 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9614 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9615 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9616
9617 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9618
9619 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9620 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9621 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9622
9623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9625
9626 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9627
9628
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009629option ssl-hello-chk
9630 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9632 yes | no | yes | yes
9633 Arguments : none
9634
9635 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9636 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9637 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9638 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9639 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9640 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9641 hello message.
9642
9643 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9644 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9645 messages, which is appreciable.
9646
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009647 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009648 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9649 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009650
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009651 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9652
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009653
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009654option tcp-check
9655 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9656 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9657 yes | no | yes | yes
9658
9659 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9660 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9661
9662 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9663 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9664 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9665
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009666 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009667 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9668 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9669 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9670 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9671 only.
9672
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009673 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009674 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009675 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9676 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9677 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9678
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009679 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009680 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9681 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009682 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009683 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9684 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9685 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9686 the respective protocols.
9687 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009688 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009689
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009690 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009691
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009692 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9693 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9694 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9695 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009696
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009697 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9698 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9699 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009700
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009701
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009702 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009703 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009704 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009705 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009706
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009707 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009708 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009709 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009710
9711 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9712 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009714 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009715 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009716 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009717 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009718 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009719 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9720 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009721 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009722 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9723 tcp-check expect string +OK
9724
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009725 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009726 (send many headers before analyzing)
9727 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009728 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009729 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9730 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9731 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9732 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009733 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009734
9735
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009736 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009737
9738
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009739option tcp-smart-accept
9740no option tcp-smart-accept
9741 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9743 yes | yes | yes | no
9744 Arguments : none
9745
9746 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9747 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9748 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9749 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9750 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9751 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9752
9753 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9754 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9755 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9756 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9757
9758 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9759 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9760 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009761 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009762
9763 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9764 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9765 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9766
9767 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9768 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9769 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9770
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009771 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9772
9773
9774option tcp-smart-connect
9775no option tcp-smart-connect
9776 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9778 yes | no | yes | yes
9779 Arguments : none
9780
9781 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9782 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9783 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9784 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9785 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9786
9787 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9788 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9789 complex.
9790
9791 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9792 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9793 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9794
9795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9797
9798 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9799
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009800
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009801option tcpka
9802 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9804 yes | yes | yes | yes
9805 Arguments : none
9806
9807 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9808 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009809 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009810 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9811
9812 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9813 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9814 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9815 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9816
9817 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9818 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9819 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9820 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9821 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9822
9823 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9824
9825 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9826 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9827 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9828 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9829 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9830 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9831 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9832 backends.
9833
9834 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9835
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009836
9837option tcplog
9838 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009840 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009841 Arguments : none
9842
9843 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9844 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9845 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9846 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9847 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9848 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9849 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9850 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9851
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009852 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009854 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009855
9856
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009857option transparent
9858no option transparent
9859 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009861 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009862 Arguments : none
9863
9864 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9865 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9866 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9867 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9868 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9869 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9870 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9871 appropriate server.
9872
9873 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9874 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9875
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009876 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009877 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009878
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009879
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009880external-check command <command>
9881 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9883 yes | no | yes | yes
9884
9885 Arguments :
9886 <command> is the external command to run
9887
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009888 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9889
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009890 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009891
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009892 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9893 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9894 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9895 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9896 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9897 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009898
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009899 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9900
9901 Environment variables :
9902 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9903 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9904
9905 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9906
9907 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9908
9909 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9910 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9911 for a UNIX socket).
9912
9913 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9914
9915 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9916
9917 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9918
9919 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9920
9921 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9922
9923 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9924 socket).
9925
9926 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9927 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9928
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009929 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9930
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009931 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9932 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9933 failed.
9934
9935 Example :
9936 external-check command /bin/true
9937
9938 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9939
9940
9941external-check path <path>
9942 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9944 yes | no | yes | yes
9945
9946 Arguments :
9947 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9948
9949 The default path is "".
9950
9951 Example :
9952 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9953
9954 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9955 "external-check command"
9956
9957
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009958persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009959persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009960 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9962 yes | no | yes | yes
9963 Arguments :
9964 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009965 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9966 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009967
9968 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9969 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009970 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009971 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9972 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9973 forwarded to this server.
9974
9975 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9976 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9977 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009978 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009979 a single "listen" section.
9980
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009981 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9982 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9983 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9984
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009985 Example :
9986 listen tse-farm
9987 bind :3389
9988 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9989 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9990 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9991 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9992 persist rdp-cookie
9993 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009994 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009995 balance rdp-cookie
9996 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9997 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9998
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01009999 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010000
10001
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010002rate-limit sessions <rate>
10003 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10005 yes | yes | yes | no
10006 Arguments :
10007 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10008 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10009
10010 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10011 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10012 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010013 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010014 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10015 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10016
10017 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10018 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10019 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10020 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10021
10022 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10023 listen smtp
10024 mode tcp
10025 bind :25
10026 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010027 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010028
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010029 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10030 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10031 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010032
10033 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10034
10035
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010036redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10037redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10038redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010039 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10041 no | yes | yes | yes
10042
10043 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010044 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010045
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010046 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010047 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010048 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10049 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10050 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010051
10052 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10053 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10054 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10055 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10056 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010057 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10058 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10059 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10060 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010061
10062 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10063 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10064 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10065 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10066 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10067 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010068 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010069 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010070 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10071 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10072 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010073
10074 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010075 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10076 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10077 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010078 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010079 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10080 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10081 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10082 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010083
10084 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010085 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010086
10087 - "drop-query"
10088 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10089 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10090 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10091 with a location-type redirect.
10092
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010093 - "append-slash"
10094 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10095 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10096 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10097 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10098
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010099 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10100 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10101 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10102 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10103 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10104 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10105 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10106
10107 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10108 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10109 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10110 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10111 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10112 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10113 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010114
10115 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10116 acl clear dst_port 80
10117 acl secure dst_port 8080
10118 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010119 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010120 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010121 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10122
10123 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010124 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10125 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10126 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010127 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010128
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010129 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10130 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10131 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10132
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010133 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010134 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010135
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010136 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010137 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10138 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10139 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010141 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010142
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010143
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010144retries <value>
10145 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10146 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10147 yes | no | yes | yes
10148 Arguments :
10149 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10150 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10151 default value is 3.
10152
10153 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10154 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10155 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10156
10157 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010158 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10159 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010160
10161 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10162 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10163
10164 See also : "option redispatch"
10165
10166
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010167retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010168 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10169 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10170 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010171 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10172 yes | no | yes | yes
10173 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010174 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10175 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10176 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10177 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10178 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010179
10180 none never retry
10181
10182 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10183 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10184
10185 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10186 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10187 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10188 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10189 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10190 processing the request.
10191
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010192 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10193 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10194 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10195 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10196 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10197 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10198 overflow attack for example).
10199
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010200 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10201 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10202 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10203 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10204 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10205 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10206 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10207 amplify denial of service attacks.
10208
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010209 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10210 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10211 considered to be safe to retry.
10212
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010213 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10214 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10215 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10216 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10217 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010218
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010219 all-retryable-errors
10220 retry request for any error that are considered
10221 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10222 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10223 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10224
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010225 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10226 not cumulative.
10227
10228 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10229 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10230 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10231 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10232
10233 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10234 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10235 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10236 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10237 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10238 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10239 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10240 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10241 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10242 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10243 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10244 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10245
10246 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10247 should not use this directive.
10248
10249 The default is "conn-failure".
10250
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010251 Example:
10252 retry-on 503 504
10253
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010254 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10255
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010256server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010257 Declare a server in a backend
10258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10259 no | no | yes | yes
10260 Arguments :
10261 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010262 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010263 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010264
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010265 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10266 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10267 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10268 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010269 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10270 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010271 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010272 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10273 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010274 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10275 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10276 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10277 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10278 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10279 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10280 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010281 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010282 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10283 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10284 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10285 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10286 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10287 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010288 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10289 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010290 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10291 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010292
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010293 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010294 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10295 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10296 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10297 adding this value to the client's port.
10298
10299 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10300 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010301 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010302
10303 Examples :
10304 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10305 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010306 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010307 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10308 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10309 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010310
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010311 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10312 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10313 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10314 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10315 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10316
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010317 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10318 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010320server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010321 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010322 this backend.
10323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 no | no | yes | yes
10325
10326 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10327 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10328 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10329 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10330 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010331
10332 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10333 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10334
10335 global
10336 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10337
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010338 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010339 load-server-state-from-file
10340
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010341 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010342 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010343
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010344server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10345 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10346 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10348 no | no | yes | yes
10349
10350 Arguments:
10351 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10352
10353 <num | range>
10354 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10355 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10356 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10357 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10358
10359 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10360
10361 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10362
10363 <params*>
10364 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10365 keyword.
10366
10367 Examples:
10368 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10369 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10370 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10371
10372 # or
10373 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10374
10375 # would be equivalent to:
10376 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10377 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10378 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10379
10380
10381
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010382source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010383source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010384source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010385 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10387 yes | no | yes | yes
10388 Arguments :
10389 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10390 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010391
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010392 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010393 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10394 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10395 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10396 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10397 supported prefixes are :
10398 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10399 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10400 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010401 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010402 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10403 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010404
10405 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10406 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010407 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10408 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10409 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010410
10411 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10412 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10413 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10414 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10415 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10416 <addr>.
10417
10418 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10419 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10420 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10421 port.
10422
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010423 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10424 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10425 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10426 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010427 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010428 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10429 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10430 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10431 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10432 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10433 HTTP header.
10434
10435 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10436 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010437 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010438 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10439 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10440 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10441 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10442 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10443 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10444 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10445
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010446 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10447 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10448 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10449 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10450 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10451 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10452
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010453 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10454 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10455 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10456 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10457
10458 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10459 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10460 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10461 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10462 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10463 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10464
10465 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10466 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10467 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10468 there are two methods :
10469
10470 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10471 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10472 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10473 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10474 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10475 of the client ranges may be used.
10476
10477 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10478 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10479 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10480 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10481 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10482 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10483 same session.
10484
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010485 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10486 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10487 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010488 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010489
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010490 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10491
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010492 Examples :
10493 backend private
10494 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10495 source 192.168.1.200
10496
10497 backend transparent_ssl1
10498 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10499 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10500
10501 backend transparent_ssl2
10502 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10503 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10504 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10505
10506 backend transparent_ssl3
10507 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10508 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10509 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10510
10511 backend transparent_smtp
10512 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10513 # with Tproxy version 4.
10514 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10515
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010516 backend transparent_http
10517 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10518 # proxy.
10519 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010521 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010522 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10523
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010524
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010525srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10526 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10527 the connection on the server side.
10528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10529 yes | no | yes | yes
10530 Arguments :
10531 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10532
10533 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10534 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010535 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10536 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010537
10538 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10539
10540
10541srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10542 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10543 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10544 server side.
10545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10546 yes | no | yes | yes
10547 Arguments :
10548 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10549 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10550 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10551 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10552
10553 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10554 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010555 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10556 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010557
10558 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10559
10560
10561srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10562 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10564 yes | no | yes | yes
10565 Arguments :
10566 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10567 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10568 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10569 document.
10570
10571 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10572 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010573 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10574 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010575
10576 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10577
10578
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010579stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10580 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010582 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010583
10584 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10585 matched.
10586
10587 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10588 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10589
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010590 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10591 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010592 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010593
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010594 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10595 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10596 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10597 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010598
10599 Example :
10600 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10601 backend stats_localhost
10602 stats enable
10603 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10604
10605 Example :
10606 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10607 backend stats_auth
10608 stats enable
10609 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10610 stats admin if TRUE
10611
10612 Example :
10613 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10614 userlist stats-auth
10615 group admin users admin
10616 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10617 group readonly users haproxy
10618 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10619
10620 backend stats_auth
10621 stats enable
10622 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10623 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10624 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10625 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10626
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010627 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10628 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10629 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010630
10631
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010632stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10633 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010635 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010636 Arguments :
10637 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10638
10639 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10640
10641 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10642 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10643 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10644 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10645 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10646 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10647
10648 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10649 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10650 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010651 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010652
10653 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10654 report using "stats scope".
10655
10656 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10657 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10658 unobvious parameters.
10659
10660 Example :
10661 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10662 backend public_www
10663 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10664 stats enable
10665 stats hide-version
10666 stats scope .
10667 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010668 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010669 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10670 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10671
10672 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10673 backend private_monitoring
10674 stats enable
10675 stats uri /admin?stats
10676 stats refresh 5s
10677
10678 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10679
10680
10681stats enable
10682 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010684 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010685 Arguments : none
10686
10687 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10688 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10689 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10690 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10691 - stats auth : no authentication
10692 - stats scope : no restriction
10693
10694 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10695 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10696 unobvious parameters.
10697
10698 Example :
10699 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10700 backend public_www
10701 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10702 stats enable
10703 stats hide-version
10704 stats scope .
10705 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010706 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010707 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10708 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10709
10710 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10711 backend private_monitoring
10712 stats enable
10713 stats uri /admin?stats
10714 stats refresh 5s
10715
10716 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10717
10718
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010719stats hide-version
10720 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010723 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010724
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010725 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10726 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10727 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10728 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10729 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10730 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010731
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010732 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10733 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10734 unobvious parameters.
10735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010736 Example :
10737 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10738 backend public_www
10739 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010740 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010741 stats hide-version
10742 stats scope .
10743 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010744 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010745 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10746 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010747
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010748 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10749 backend private_monitoring
10750 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751 stats uri /admin?stats
10752 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010753
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010754 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010755
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010756
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010757stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10758 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10759 Access control for statistics
10760
10761 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10762 no | no | yes | yes
10763
10764 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10765 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10766 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10767 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10768 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10769 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10770
10771 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10772 instance.
10773
10774 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10775 about ACL usage.
10776
10777
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010778stats realm <realm>
10779 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010781 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010782 Arguments :
10783 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10784 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10785 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10786
10787 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10788 using a backslash ('\').
10789
10790 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10791 only related to authentication.
10792
10793 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10794 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10795 unobvious parameters.
10796
10797 Example :
10798 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10799 backend public_www
10800 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10801 stats enable
10802 stats hide-version
10803 stats scope .
10804 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010805 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010806 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10807 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10808
10809 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10810 backend private_monitoring
10811 stats enable
10812 stats uri /admin?stats
10813 stats refresh 5s
10814
10815 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10816
10817
10818stats refresh <delay>
10819 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010821 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010822 Arguments :
10823 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10824 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10825 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10826 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10827 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10828 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10829
10830 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10831 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10832 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010833 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010834
10835 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10836 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10837 unobvious parameters.
10838
10839 Example :
10840 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10841 backend public_www
10842 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10843 stats enable
10844 stats hide-version
10845 stats scope .
10846 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010847 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010848 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10849 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10850
10851 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10852 backend private_monitoring
10853 stats enable
10854 stats uri /admin?stats
10855 stats refresh 5s
10856
10857 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10858
10859
10860stats scope { <name> | "." }
10861 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010863 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010864 Arguments :
10865 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10866 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10867 section in which the statement appears.
10868
10869 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10870 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10871 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10872 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10873 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10874 exists.
10875
10876 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10877 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10878 unobvious parameters.
10879
10880 Example :
10881 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10882 backend public_www
10883 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10884 stats enable
10885 stats hide-version
10886 stats scope .
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10890 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10891
10892 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10893 backend private_monitoring
10894 stats enable
10895 stats uri /admin?stats
10896 stats refresh 5s
10897
10898 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10899
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010900
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010901stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010902 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010905
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010906 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010907 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10908
10909 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10910 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10911
10912 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10913 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010914 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010915
10916 Example :
10917 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10918 backend private_monitoring
10919 stats enable
10920 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10921 stats uri /admin?stats
10922 stats refresh 5s
10923
10924 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10925 global section.
10926
10927
10928stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010929 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10931 yes | yes | yes | yes
10932 Arguments : none
10933
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010934 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010935 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10936 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10937 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10938 - IP (socket, server)
10939 - cookie (backend, server)
10940
10941 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10942 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010943 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010944
10945 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10946
10947
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010948stats show-modules
10949 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10951 yes | yes | yes | yes
10952 Arguments : none
10953
10954 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10955 values as a tooltip.
10956
10957 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10958 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10959 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10960
10961 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10962
10963
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010964stats show-node [ <name> ]
10965 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010967 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010968 Arguments:
10969 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10970 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10971
10972 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10973 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010974 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010975
10976 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10977 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10978 unobvious parameters.
10979
10980 Example:
10981 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10982 backend private_monitoring
10983 stats enable
10984 stats show-node Europe-1
10985 stats uri /admin?stats
10986 stats refresh 5s
10987
10988 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10989 section.
10990
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010991
10992stats uri <prefix>
10993 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010995 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010996 Arguments :
10997 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10998 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10999 query string.
11000
11001 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11002 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11003 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11004 possible to reach it in the application.
11005
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011006 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011007 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011008 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11009 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11010 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11011 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11012
11013 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11014 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11015 an address or a port to statistics only.
11016
11017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11019 unobvious parameters.
11020
11021 Example :
11022 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11023 backend public_www
11024 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11025 stats enable
11026 stats hide-version
11027 stats scope .
11028 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011029 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011030 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11031 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11032
11033 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11034 backend private_monitoring
11035 stats enable
11036 stats uri /admin?stats
11037 stats refresh 5s
11038
11039 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11040
11041
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011042stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11043 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011045 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011046
11047 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011048 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011049 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011050 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011051 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11052
11053 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11054 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11055 the "stick-table" statement.
11056
11057 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11058 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11059 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11060 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11061 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11062
11063 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11064 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11065 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11066 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11067 transformation rules.
11068
11069 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11070 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11071 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11072 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11073 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11074 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11075 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11076
11077 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11078 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11079 ACL based conditions.
11080
11081 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11082 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11083 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11084 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11085
11086 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11087 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11088 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11089 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11090
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011091 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11092 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011093 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011094
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011095 Example :
11096 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11097 # last 30 minutes
11098 backend pop
11099 mode tcp
11100 balance roundrobin
11101 stick store-request src
11102 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11103 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11104 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11105
11106 backend smtp
11107 mode tcp
11108 balance roundrobin
11109 stick match src table pop
11110 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11111 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11112
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011113 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011114 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011115
11116
11117stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11118 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11120 no | no | yes | yes
11121
11122 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11123 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11124 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11125 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11126
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011127 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11128 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011129 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011130
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011131 Examples :
11132 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011133 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011134
11135 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11136 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11137 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11138
11139
11140 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11141 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11142 backend http
11143 mode http
11144 balance roundrobin
11145 stick on src table https
11146 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11147 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11148 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11149
11150 backend https
11151 mode tcp
11152 balance roundrobin
11153 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11154 stick on src
11155 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11156 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11157
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011158 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011159
11160
11161stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11162 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11164 no | no | yes | yes
11165
11166 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011167 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011168 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011169 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011170 server is selected.
11171
11172 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11173 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11174 the "stick-table" statement.
11175
11176 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11177 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11178 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11179 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11180 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11181 address.
11182
11183 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11184 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11185 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11186 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11187 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11188 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11189 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11190 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11191 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11192 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11193
11194 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11195 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11196 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11197 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11198 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11199 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11200 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11201
11202 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11203 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11204 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11205 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11206
11207 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11208 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11209 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11210 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11211 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11212 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011213 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11214 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11215 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11216 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11217 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11218 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011219
11220 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11221 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11222 the request.
11223
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011224 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11225 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011226 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011227
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011228 Example :
11229 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11230 # last 30 minutes
11231 backend pop
11232 mode tcp
11233 balance roundrobin
11234 stick store-request src
11235 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11236 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11237 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11238
11239 backend smtp
11240 mode tcp
11241 balance roundrobin
11242 stick match src table pop
11243 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11244 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11245
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011246 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011247 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011248
11249
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011250stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011251 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011252 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011253 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011255 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011256
11257 Arguments :
11258 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11259 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11260 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11261 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11262
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011263 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11264 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11265 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11266 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11267
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011268 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11269 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11270 instance.
11271
11272 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11273 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11274 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11275 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11276 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11277 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011278 to 32 characters.
11279
11280 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11281 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11282 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011283 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011284 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11285 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011286
11287 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011288 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11289 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011290 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11291 increase.
11292
11293 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011294 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11295 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11296 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011297
11298 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011299 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011300 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11301 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011302 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011303 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11304 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11305 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11306 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11307 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11308 parameter (see below).
11309
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011310 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11311 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11312 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11313 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11314 soft restart.
11315
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011316 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11317 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011318
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011319 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11320 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11321 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11322 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011323 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011324 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011325 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11326 if not expiration delay is specified.
11327
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011328 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11329 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11330 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11331 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11332 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11333 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11334 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11335 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11336 token.
11337
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011338 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11339 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11340 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11341 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011342 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11343 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11344 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11345 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11346 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11347 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11348 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11349 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11350 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11351 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11352 types and their arguments.
11353
11354 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11355 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11356 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11357 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11358
11359 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11360 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11361 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011362 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011363
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011364 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11365 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11366 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011367 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011368 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011369 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011370
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011371 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11372 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11373 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11374 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11375
11376 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11377 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11378 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11379 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11380 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11381 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11382
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011383 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11384 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11385 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11386 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11387
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011388 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11389 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11390 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11391 they were received.
11392
11393 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11394 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11395 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11396 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11397 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11398
11399 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11400 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11401 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11402 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11403 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11404
11405 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11406 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11407 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11408
11409 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11410 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11411 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11412 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11413 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11414
11415 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11416 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11417 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11418 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11419 the client side.
11420
11421 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11422 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11423 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11424 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11425 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11426 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11427 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11428
11429 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11430 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11431 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11432 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11433 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11434 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011436
11437 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11438 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11439 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11440 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11441 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11442 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11443
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011444 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11445 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11446 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11447 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11448 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11449
11450 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11451 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11452 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11453 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11454 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11455 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11456
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011457 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011458 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011459 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11460 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11461
11462 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11463 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11464 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11465 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11466 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11467 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11468 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11469 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11470 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11471 recommended for better fairness.
11472
11473 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011474 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011475 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11476 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11477
11478 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11479 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11480 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11481 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11482 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11483 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11484 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11485 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11486 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11487 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011488
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011489 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11490 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011491 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11492 reference it.
11493
11494 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11495 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011496 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11497 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11498 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011499
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011500 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11501 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11502 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11503 something that can be ignored.
11504
11505 Example:
11506 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11507 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11508 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11509 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11510
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011511 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011512 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011513
11514
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011515stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011516 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11518 no | no | yes | yes
11519
11520 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011521 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011522 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011523 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011524 server is selected.
11525
11526 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11527 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11528 the "stick-table" statement.
11529
11530 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11531 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11532 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11533 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11534
11535 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11536 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11537 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11538 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11539 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11540 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011541 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011542 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11543 rules.
11544
11545 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11546 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11547 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11548 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11549 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11550 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11551 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11552
11553 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11554 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11555 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11556 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11557
11558 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11559 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11560 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11561 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11562 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11563 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011564 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11565 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11566 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11567 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11568 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11569 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11570 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11571 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11572 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011573
11574 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11575
11576 Example :
11577 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11578 backend https
11579 mode tcp
11580 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011581 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011582 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011583
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011584 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11585 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011586
11587 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11588 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11589 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11590
11591 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11592 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011593
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011594 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11595 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11596 # at offset 44.
11597
11598 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011599 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011600
11601 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011602 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011603
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011604 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11605 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11606
11607 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11608 extraction.
11609
11610
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011611tcp-check comment <string>
11612 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11613 it fails.
11614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11615 yes | no | yes | yes
11616
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011617 Arguments :
11618 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11619 rule fails.
11620
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011621 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11622 user-friendly error reporting.
11623
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011624 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11625 "tcp-check expect".
11626
11627
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011628tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11629 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011630 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011631 Opens a new connection
11632 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011633 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011634
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011635 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011636 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11637
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011638 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011639 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011640
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011641 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011642 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11643 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011644 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011645
11646 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011647
11648 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11649
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011650 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11651
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011652 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11653
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011654 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11655
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011656 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11657 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11658 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11659 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11660
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011661 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11662 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11663 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11664 haproxy -vv.
11665
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011666 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011667
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011668 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11669 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11670 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11671
11672 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11673 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11674 of the sequence.
11675
11676 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11677 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11678 do.
11679
11680 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11681 unset-var or comment rules.
11682
11683 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011684 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11685 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11686 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11687 option tcp-check
11688 tcp-check connect
11689 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11690 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11691 tcp-check send \r\n
11692 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11693 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11694 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11695 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11696 tcp-check send \r\n
11697 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11698 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11699
11700 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11701 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011702 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011703 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11704 tcp-check connect port 143
11705 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11706 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11707
11708 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11709
11710
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011711tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011712 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011713 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011714 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011715 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011717 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011718
11719 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011720 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11721
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011722 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11723 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11724 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11725 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11726 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11727 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11728 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11729 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11730 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11731 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11732
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011733 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011734 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11735 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011736 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11737 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11738 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11739
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011740 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11741 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11742 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011743 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11744 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011745 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11746 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011747 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11748 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011749 By default "L7OK" is used.
11750
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011751 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11752 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011753 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11754 supported :
11755 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11756 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011757 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11758 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11759 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11760 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11761 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011762
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011763 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011764 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011765 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11766 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11767 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11768 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011769 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11770
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011771 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11772 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11773 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11774 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11775
11776 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11777 informational message reported in logs if an error
11778 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11779 log-format string.
11780
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011781 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11782 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11783 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11784 followed by some converters.
11785
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011786 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11787 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11788 with the usual backslash ('\').
11789 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011790 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11792 used upper or lower case.
11793
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011794 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11795
11796 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11797 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11798 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11799 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11800 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11801 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11802 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11803 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11804
11805 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11806 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11807 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11808 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11809 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11810 expression.
11811
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011812 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11813 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11814 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11815 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11816 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11817 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11818
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011819 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11820 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11821 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11822 this exact hexadecimal string.
11823 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11824
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011825 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11826 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11827 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11828 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11829 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11830 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11831 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11832 size.
11833
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011834 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11835 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11836 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11837 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11838 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11839 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11840 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11841 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11842 in a binary string before matching the response's
11843 buffer.
11844
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011845 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011846 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011847 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11848 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11849 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11850 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11851 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11852 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11853 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11854 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11855 the null character.
11856
11857 Examples :
11858 # perform a POP check
11859 option tcp-check
11860 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11861
11862 # perform an IMAP check
11863 option tcp-check
11864 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11865
11866 # look for the redis master server
11867 option tcp-check
11868 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011869 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011870 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11871 tcp-check expect string role:master
11872 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11873 tcp-check expect string +OK
11874
11875
11876 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011877 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011878
11879
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011880tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11881tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11882 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11883 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011885 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011886
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011887 Arguments :
11888 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11889
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011890 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11891 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011892
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011893 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11894 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011895
11896 Examples :
11897 # look for the redis master server
11898 option tcp-check
11899 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11900 tcp-check expect string role:master
11901
11902 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011903 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011904
11905
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011906tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11907tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11908 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11909 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011911 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011912
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011913 Arguments :
11914 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011915
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011916 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11917 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011918
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011919 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11920 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11921 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011922
11923 Examples :
11924 # redis check in binary
11925 option tcp-check
11926 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11927 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11928
11929
11930 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011931 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011932
11933
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011934tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011935 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011937 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011938
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011939 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011940 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11941 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11942 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11943 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11944 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11945 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11946 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11947 and '-'.
11948
11949 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11950
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011951 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011952 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11953
11954
11955tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011956 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011958 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011959
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011960 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011961 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11962 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11963 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11964 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11965 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11967 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11968 and '-'.
11969
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011970 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011971 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11972
11973
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011974tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11975 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11977 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011978 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011979 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11980 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011982 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011983
11984 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11985 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011986 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11987 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11988 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11989 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11990 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11991 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011993 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11994 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11995 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11996 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011997
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011998 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011999 - accept :
12000 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12001 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12002 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012004 - reject :
12005 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12006 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12007 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12008 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12009 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12010 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12011 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12012 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12013 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12014 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12015 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012016 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012017
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012018 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12019 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12020 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12021 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12022 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12023 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12024 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12025 hosts.
12026
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012027 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12028 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12029 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12030 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12031 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12032 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12033 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12034 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12035
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012036 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12037 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12038 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12039 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12040 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12041 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12042 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12043 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12044 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012045 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12046 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012047
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012048 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012049 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012050 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12051 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12052 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012053 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012054 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012055 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12056 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12057 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12058 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12059 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12060 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12061 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012062
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012063 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012064 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012066 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012067 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12068 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12069 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012071 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12072 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12073 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12074 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012076 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12077 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12078 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12079 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12080 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012081 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12082 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12083 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12084 layer7 information is extracted.
12085
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012086 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12087 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12088 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12089 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12090 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012091
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012092 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12093 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12094 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12095 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12096
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012097 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12098 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12099 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12100 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12101
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012102 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12103 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12104 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12105 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12106 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012107
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012108 - set-src <expr> :
12109 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12110 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12111 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012112 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012114 Arguments:
12115 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12116 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012117
12118 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012119 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12120
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012121 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12122 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012123
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012124 - set-src-port <expr> :
12125 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12126 expression.
12127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012128 Arguments:
12129 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12130 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012131
12132 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012133 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12134
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012135 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12136 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12137 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012138
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012139 - set-dst <expr> :
12140 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12141 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12142 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12143 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12144 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12145
12146 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12147 followed by some converters.
12148
12149 Example:
12150
12151 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12152 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12153
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012154 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12155 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12156
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012157 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12158 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12159 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12160 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12161
12162
12163 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12164 followed by some converters.
12165
12166 Example:
12167
12168 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12169
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012170 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12171 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12172 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12173
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012174 - "silent-drop" :
12175 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012176 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012177 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12178 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12179 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12180 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12181 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012182 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12183 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012184 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12185 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012186 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012187 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12188 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12189 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12190 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012192 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12193 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12194 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012195
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012196 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12197 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12198 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012199
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012200 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012201 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012202 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012204 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12205 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12206 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012207
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012208 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012209 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12210 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012211
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012212 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12213
12214 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12215
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012216 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12217
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012218 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012219
12220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012221tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12222 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012224 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012225 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012226 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12227 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012229 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012230
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012231 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012232 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12233 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012234 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12235 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012237 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12238 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12239 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12240 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012241 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012242 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012243 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12244 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12245 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12246 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012247 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012248 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012250 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12251 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12252 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12253 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012254
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012255 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012256 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012257 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012258 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12259 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012260 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012261 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012262 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012263 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012264 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012265 - set-dst <expr>
12266 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012267 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012268 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012269 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012270 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012271 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012272 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012274 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12275 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012276 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12277 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012278
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012279 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12280 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12281 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12282 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12283 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12284 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012285
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012286 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12288 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012289
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012290 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12291 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12292 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12293 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12294 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12295 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12296
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012297 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012298 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12299 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12300 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12301 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12302 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12303 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12304 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12305 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12306 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12307 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012308
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012309 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012310 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12311 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12312 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012313
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012314 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12315 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12316
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012317 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012318 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12319 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012320
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012321 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12322 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012323 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012324 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12325 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012326 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012327 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012328 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12330 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012331 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012332 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12333 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012334
12335 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12336 followed by some converters.
12337
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012338 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012339 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12340 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12341 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12342 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12343 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12344 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012345 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012346 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12347 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12348
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012349 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12350
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012351 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12352 <var-name>.
12353
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012354 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12355 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12356 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12357 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12358 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12359
12360 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12361 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12362 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12363 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12364 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12365 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12366 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12367 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12368 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12369 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12370 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12371
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012372 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12373 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12374 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12375 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12376 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12377
12378 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12379
12380 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12381
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012382 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12383 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12384 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12385 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12386 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12387 evaluated.
12388
12389 Example:
12390 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12391
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012392 Example:
12393
12394 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012395 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012396
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012397 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012398 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012399 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012400 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12401 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012402 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012403 tcp-request content reject
12404
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012405 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12406 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12407 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12408 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12409 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12410 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12411 ...
12412 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12413
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012414 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012415 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12416 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012417 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012418 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012419
12420 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12421 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012422 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012423 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012424 tcp-request content reject
12425
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012426 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012427 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012428 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012429 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012430 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12431 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012432
12433 Example:
12434 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12435 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012436 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012437
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012438 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012439 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012440
12441 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012442 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012443 # protecting all our sites
12444 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012445 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12446 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012447 ...
12448 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12449
12450 backend http_dynamic
12451 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012452 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012453 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012454 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012455 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012456 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012457 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012459 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012460
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012461 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12462 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012463
12464
12465tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12466 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012468 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012469 Arguments :
12470 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12471 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12472 as explained at the top of this document.
12473
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012474 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012475 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12476 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12477 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12478 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12479
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012480 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12481 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12482 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12483 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12484
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012485 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012486 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012487 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012488 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012489 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012490 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12491 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12492 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012493
12494 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12495 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12496 it pass through unaffected.
12497
12498 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12499 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12500 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012501 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012502 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12503 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012504 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12505 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12506 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012507
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012508 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012509 "timeout client".
12510
12511
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012512tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12513 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12515 no | no | yes | yes
12516 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012517 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12518 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012519
12520 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12521
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012522 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012523 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12524 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012525 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12526 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012527
12528 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12529
12530 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12531 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12532 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12533 inserted.
12534
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012535 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012536 - accept :
12537 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12538 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12539 the rules evaluation.
12540
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012541 - close :
12542 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12543 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12544 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12545 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12546 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12547 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012548 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012549 protocols.
12550
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012551 - reject :
12552 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12553 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012554 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012555
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012556 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012557 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012558
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012559 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12560 Unsets a variable.
12561
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012562 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12563 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12564 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12565 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12566
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012567 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12568 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12569 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12570 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12571
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012572 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12573 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12574 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12575 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12576 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012577
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012578 - "silent-drop" :
12579 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012580 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012581 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12582 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12583 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12584 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12585 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012586 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12587 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012588 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12589 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012590 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012591 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12592 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12593 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12594 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12595
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012596 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12597 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12598
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012599 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12600 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12601 for changing the default action to a reject.
12602
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012603 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12604 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12605 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12606 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012607 period.
12608
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012609 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12610 declared inline.
12611
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012612 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12613 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012614 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012615 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12616 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012617 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012618 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012619 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012620 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12621 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012622 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012623 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12624 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012625
12626 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12627 followed by some converters.
12628
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012629 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12630 <var-name>.
12631
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012632 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12633 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12634 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12635 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12636 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12637
12638 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12639
12640 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12641
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012642 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12643
12644 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12645
12646
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012647tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12648 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12650 no | yes | yes | no
12651 Arguments :
12652 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12653 below.
12654
12655 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12656
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012657 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012658 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12659 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12660 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12661 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12662 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12663 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12664 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012665 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012666 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12667 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12668 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12669 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12670 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12671 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12672 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12673 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12674 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12675 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12676 instead.
12677
12678 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12679 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12680 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12681 rules which may be inserted.
12682
12683 Several types of actions are supported :
12684 - accept : the request is accepted
12685 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12686 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12687 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012688 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012689 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012690 - set-dst <expr>
12691 - set-dst-port <expr>
12692 - set-src <expr>
12693 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012694 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012695 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012696 - silent-drop
12697
12698 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12699 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12700 sections for a complete description.
12701
12702 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12703 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12704 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12705
12706 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12707 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12708 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12709 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12710 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12711
12712 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12713 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12714
12715 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12716 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12717 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12718
12719 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12720 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12721 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12722
12723 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12724 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12725 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12726
12727 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12728 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12729 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12730
12731 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12732
12733 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12734
12735
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012736tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12737 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12739 no | no | yes | yes
12740 Arguments :
12741 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12742 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12743 as explained at the top of this document.
12744
12745 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12746
12747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012748timeout check <timeout>
12749 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12750 established.
12751
12752 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12753 yes | no | yes | yes
12754 Arguments:
12755 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12756 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12757 as explained at the top of this document.
12758
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012759 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012760 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012761 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012762 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012763 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12764 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12765 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012766
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012767 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012768 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12769
12770 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12771 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012772 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012773
12774 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12775 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12776 forget about it.
12777
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012778 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12779 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012780
12781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012782timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012783 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12785 yes | yes | yes | no
12786 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012787 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012788 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12789 as explained at the top of this document.
12790
12791 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12792 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12793 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012794 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12795 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12796 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12797 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012798 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12799 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12800 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012801 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012802 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012803 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12804 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012805 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12806 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012807
12808 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12809 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12810 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12811 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012812 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012813 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12814
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012815 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012816
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012817 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012819
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012820timeout client-fin <timeout>
12821 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12823 yes | yes | yes | no
12824 Arguments :
12825 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12826 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12827 as explained at the top of this document.
12828
12829 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12830 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12831 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12832 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12833 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12834 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12835 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012836 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12837 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12838 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012839
12840 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12841 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12842 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12843
12844 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12845
12846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012847timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012848 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12850 yes | no | yes | yes
12851 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012852 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12854 as explained at the top of this document.
12855
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012856 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012857 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012858 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012859 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012860 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12861 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012862
12863 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12864 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12865 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12866 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012867 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012868 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12869
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012870 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012871
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012873timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12874 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12876 yes | yes | yes | yes
12877 Arguments :
12878 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12879 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12880 as explained at the top of this document.
12881
12882 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12883 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12884 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12885 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12886 once the request has started to present itself.
12887
12888 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12889 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12890 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12891 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12892 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12893
12894 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12895 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12896 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12897 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12898
12899 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12900 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012902 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12903 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012904 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012905
12906 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12907 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12908 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12909 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12910
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012911 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12912 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012913 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12914
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012915 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12916
12917
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012918timeout http-request <timeout>
12919 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012921 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012922 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012923 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012924 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12925 as explained at the top of this document.
12926
12927 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12928 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12929 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12930 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12931 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12932 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12933 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012934 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12935 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12936 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12937 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012938 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012939 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12940 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012941
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012942 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12943 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12944 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12945 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12946 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012947 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012948
12949 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12950 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012951 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012952 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12953 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12954
12955 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012956 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12957 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12958 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012959
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012960 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012961 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012962
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012963
12964timeout queue <timeout>
12965 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12967 yes | no | yes | yes
12968 Arguments :
12969 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12970 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12971 as explained at the top of this document.
12972
12973 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12974 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12975 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12976 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12977 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12978
12979 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12980 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12981 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12982 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12983
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012984 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012985
12986
12987timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012988 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12990 yes | no | yes | yes
12991 Arguments :
12992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12994 as explained at the top of this document.
12995
12996 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12997 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12998 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12999 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13000 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13001 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13002 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13003
13004 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13005 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13006 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13007 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13008 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013009 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013010 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013011 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13012 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013013 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13014 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013015
13016 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13017 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13018 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13019 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013020 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013021 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13022
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013023 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013024
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013025
13026timeout server-fin <timeout>
13027 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13029 yes | no | yes | yes
13030 Arguments :
13031 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13032 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13033 as explained at the top of this document.
13034
13035 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13036 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13037 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13038 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13039 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13040 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13041 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13042 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13043 situations, it should not be needed.
13044
13045 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13046 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13047 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13048
13049 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13050
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013051
13052timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013053 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13055 yes | yes | yes | yes
13056 Arguments :
13057 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13058 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13059 as explained at the top of this document.
13060
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013061 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13062 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13063 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013064
13065 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13066 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13067 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13068 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013069 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013070
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013071 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013072
13073
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013074timeout tunnel <timeout>
13075 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13077 yes | no | yes | yes
13078 Arguments :
13079 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13080 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13081 as explained at the top of this document.
13082
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013083 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013084 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13085 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13086 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013087 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13088 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013089 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13090 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13091 specified.
13092
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013093 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13094 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13095 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13096 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13097 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13098 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13099 state.
13100
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013101 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13102 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13103 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13104 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013105 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013106
13107 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13108 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13109 forget about it.
13110
13111 Example :
13112 defaults http
13113 option http-server-close
13114 timeout connect 5s
13115 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013116 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013117 timeout server 30s
13118 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13119
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013120 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013121
13122
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013123transparent (deprecated)
13124 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013126 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013127 Arguments : none
13128
13129 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13130 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13131 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13132 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13133 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13134 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13135 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13136 appropriate server.
13137
13138 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13139
13140 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13141 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13142
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013143 See also: "option transparent"
13144
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013145unique-id-format <string>
13146 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13148 yes | yes | yes | no
13149 Arguments :
13150 <string> is a log-format string.
13151
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013152 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13153 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13154 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13155 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013157 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013158 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013159 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13160 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13161 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13162 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13163 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13164 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013165
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013166 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13167 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013168
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013169 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013170
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013171 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013172
13173 will generate:
13174
13175 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13176
13177 See also: "unique-id-header"
13178
13179unique-id-header <name>
13180 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13182 yes | yes | yes | no
13183 Arguments :
13184 <name> is the name of the header.
13185
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013186 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13187 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013188
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013189 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013190
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013191 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013192 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13193
13194 will generate:
13195
13196 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13197
13198 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013199
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013200use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013201 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13203 no | yes | yes | no
13204 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013205 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13206 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013207
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013208 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13209 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013210
13211 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13212 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13213 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013214 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013215 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013216 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13217 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013218
13219 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13220 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13221 assign the backend.
13222
13223 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13224 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13225 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13226 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13227 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13228 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13229
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013230 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013231 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013232 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13233 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13234 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13235
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013236 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13237 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13238 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13239 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13240 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13241 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13242 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13243 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13244 cannot be forced from the request.
13245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013246 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013247 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13248 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13249
13250 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13251 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013252
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013253use-fcgi-app <name>
13254 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13256 no | no | yes | yes
13257 Arguments :
13258 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13259
13260 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013261
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013262use-server <server> if <condition>
13263use-server <server> unless <condition>
13264 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13266 no | no | yes | yes
13267 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013268 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13269 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013270
13271 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13272
13273 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13274 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13275 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13276
13277 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13278 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13279 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13280 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13281 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13282 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13283 matches will assign the server.
13284
13285 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13286 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13287 with the next rules until one matches.
13288
13289 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13290 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13291 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13292 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13293
13294 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13295 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13296 stripped.
13297
13298 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13299 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013300 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013301 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013302 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013303
13304 Example :
13305 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013306 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013307 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013308 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013309 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013310 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013311 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013312 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13313 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13314
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013315 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13316 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13317 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13318 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013319 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013320 and we fall back to load balancing.
13321
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013322 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013323
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013324
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133255. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013326--------------------------
13327
13328The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13329depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13330settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13331written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13332described in this section.
13333
13334
133355.1. Bind options
13336-----------------
13337
13338The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13339as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13340no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13341parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13342while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13343provided immediately after the setting name.
13344
13345The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13346
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013347accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13348 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13349 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13350 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13351 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13352 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13353 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13354 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13355 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13356 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013357 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13358 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13359 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013361accept-proxy
13362 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013363 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13364 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013365 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13366 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13367 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13368 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013369 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013370 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13371 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013372 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13373 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013374
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013375allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013376 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013377 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013378 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013379 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13380 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013381
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013382alpn <protocols>
13383 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13384 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13385 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013386 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013387 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013388 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13389 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13390 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13391 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13392 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13393 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13394 preference, like below :
13395
13396 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013398backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013399 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013400 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13401
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013402curves <curves>
13403 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13404 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13405 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13406 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13407 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13408 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13409
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013410ecdhe <named curve>
13411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013412 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13413 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013414
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013415ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013416 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13417 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13418 client's certificate.
13419
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013420ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13422 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13423 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13424 error is ignored.
13425
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013426ca-sign-file <cafile>
13427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13428 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13429 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13430 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13431 'generate-certificates' for details.
13432
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013433ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013434 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13435 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13436 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13437 'generate-certificates' for details.
13438
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013439ca-verify-file <cafile>
13440 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13441 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13442 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13443 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13444 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013446ciphers <ciphers>
13447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13448 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013449 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013450 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013451 information and recommendations see e.g.
13452 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13453 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13454 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13455
13456ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13458 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13459 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13460 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013461 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13462 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013463
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013464crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13466 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013467 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13468 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013470crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13472 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13473 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13474 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13475 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013476 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13477 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013478
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013479 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13480 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13481
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013482 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13483 are loaded.
13484
13485 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013486 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13487 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13488 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13489 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13490 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13491 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13492 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013493 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013494
13495 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13496 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13497 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13498 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013499 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13500 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013501
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013502 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013504 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013505 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013506 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13507 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013508 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13509 clients).
13510
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013511 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013512 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13513 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13514 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13515 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13516 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13517 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13518 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13519 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13520 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13521 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13522 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13523 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13524
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013525 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013526 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13527 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13528 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13529 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13530
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013531 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13532 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13533 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13534 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013535
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013536 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13537 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13538 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013539
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013540crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013541 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013543 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013544 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013545
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013546crt-list <file>
13547 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013548 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13549 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013550
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013551 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13552
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013553 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13554 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13555 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13556 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13557 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013558
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013559 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013560 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13561 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13562 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13563 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13564 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013565 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13566 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13567 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013568
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013569 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13570 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13571 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013572
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013573 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13574
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013575 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013576 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013577 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13578 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13579 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13580 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13581 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13582 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013583
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013584 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013585 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013586 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013587 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013588 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013589 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013590
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013591defer-accept
13592 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13593 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13594 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013595 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013596 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13597 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13598 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13599 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13600 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13601 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13602 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13603
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013604expose-fd listeners
13605 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13606 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013607 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13608 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013609 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013610
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013611force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013612 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013613 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013614 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013615 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013616
13617force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013618 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013619 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013620 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013621
13622force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013623 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013624 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013625 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013626
13627force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013628 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013629 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013630 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013631
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013632force-tlsv13
13633 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13634 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013635 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013636
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013637generate-certificates
13638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13639 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13640 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13641 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13642 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13643 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13644 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13645 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13646 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13647 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13648 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13649
13650 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13651 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013652 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013653 certificate is used many times.
13654
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013655gid <gid>
13656 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13657 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13658 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13659 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13660 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13661
13662group <group>
13663 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13664 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13665 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13666 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13667 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13668
13669id <id>
13670 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13671 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13672 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13673 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13674
13675interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013676 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13677 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13678 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13679 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13680 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13681 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013682 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13683 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13684 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13685 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13686 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13687 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013688
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013689level <level>
13690 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13691 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13692 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013693 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013694 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13695 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13696 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013698 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013699 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013700 all counters).
13701
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013702severity-output <format>
13703 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13704 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13705 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13706 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13707 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13708 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13709 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13710 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13711 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13712 rfc5424 convention.
13713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013714maxconn <maxconn>
13715 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13716 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13717 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13718 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13719 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13720 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13721 eat all memory.
13722
13723mode <mode>
13724 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13725 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13726 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13727 UNIX sockets.
13728
13729mss <maxseg>
13730 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13731 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13732 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13733 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13734 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13735 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13736 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13737 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13738 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13739 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13740 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13741
13742name <name>
13743 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13744 page.
13745
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013746namespace <name>
13747 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13748 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13749 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13750 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013752nice <nice>
13753 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13754 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13755 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13756 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13757 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13758 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13759 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13760 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13761 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13762 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13763 one for an RDP socket.
13764
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013765no-ca-names
13766 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13767 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013768 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013769
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013770no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013771 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013772 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013773 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013774 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013775 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13776 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013777
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013778no-tls-tickets
13779 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13780 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13781 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013782 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13783 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013784 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13785 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13786 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013787
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013788no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013789 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013790 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013791 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013792 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013793 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13794 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013795
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013796no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013798 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013799 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013800 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013801 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13802 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013803
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013804no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013805 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013806 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013807 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013808 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013809 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13810 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013811
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013812no-tlsv13
13813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13814 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13815 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13816 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013817 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13818 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013819
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013820npn <protocols>
13821 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13822 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13823 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013824 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013825 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013826 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13827 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13828 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13829 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13830 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013831
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013832prefer-client-ciphers
13833 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13834 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13835 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013836 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13837 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13838 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013839
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013840process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013841 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013842 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013843 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013844 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13845 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13846 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13847 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013848 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013849 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13850 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13851 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13852 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13853 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013854
13855 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13856
13857 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13858 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13859 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13860 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13861 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13862 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13863 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13864 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013865
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013866proto <name>
13867 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13868 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13869 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013870 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13871 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13872
13873 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13874 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13875 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13876 also reported (flag=HTX).
13877
13878 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13879 a bind line :
13880
13881 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13882 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13883 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13884
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013885 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013886 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013887 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013888 h2" on the bind line.
13889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013890ssl
13891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013892 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013893 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13894 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013895 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13896 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013897
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013898ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13899 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013900 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13901 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13902 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013903 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13904
13905ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013906 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13907 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13908 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13909 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013910
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013911strict-sni
13912 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13913 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13914 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13915 See the "crt" option for more information.
13916
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013917tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013918 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013919 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013920 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013921 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013922 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13923 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13924 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13925 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13926 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13927 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13928 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13929
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013930tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013931 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013932 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13933 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13934 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13935 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13936 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13937 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13938 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013939 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13940 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13941 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013942
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013943tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13944 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013945 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13946 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13947 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13948 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13949 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13950 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13951 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13952 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13953 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13954 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013955 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13956 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13957
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013958transparent
13959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13960 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13961 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13962 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13963 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13964 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13965 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13966 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13967 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13968 so check for support with your vendor.
13969
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013970v4v6
13971 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13972 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13973 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13974 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013975 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013976
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013977v6only
13978 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13979 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13980 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013981 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13982 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013984uid <uid>
13985 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13986 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13987 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13988 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13989 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13990
13991user <user>
13992 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13993 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13994 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13995 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13996 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13997
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013998verify [none|optional|required]
13999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14000 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14001 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14002 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14003 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014004 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14005 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14006 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14007 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014008
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140095.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014010------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014012The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14013which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14014arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14015settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14016after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14017Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14018address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014020 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014021 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014022
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014023Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14024keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014026The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014027
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014028addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014029 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014030 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14031 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14032 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14033 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14034 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014035
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014036agent-check
14037 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014038 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014039 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14040 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14041 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014042
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014043 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014044 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014045 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014046 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14047 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014048
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014049 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14050 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14051 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14052 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14053 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014055 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014057
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014058 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14059 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14060 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014061
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014062 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14063 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14064 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014065
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014066 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014067 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14068 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14069 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14070 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014071 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014072 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014074 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14075 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014076
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014077 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14078 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14079 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14080 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14081 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14082 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14083 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14084 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14085 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014086
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014087 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14088 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014089 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14090 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14091 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014092 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014093
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014094 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014095 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014096
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014097agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014098 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014099 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14100 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14101 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14102 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14103
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014104agent-inter <delay>
14105 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14106 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14107
14108 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14109 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14110 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14111 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14112 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14113 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14114 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14115 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14116 of backends use the same servers.
14117
14118 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14119
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014120agent-addr <addr>
14121 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14122
14123 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014124 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014125 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14126 hostname, it will be resolved.
14127
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014128agent-port <port>
14129 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14130
14131 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14132
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014133allow-0rtt
14134 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014135 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14136 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014137
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014138alpn <protocols>
14139 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14140 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14141 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014142 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014143 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14144 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14145 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14146 now obsolete NPN extension.
14147 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14148 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14149
14150 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14151
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014152 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014154backup
14155 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14156 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14157 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14158 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014159 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14160 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014161
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014162ca-file <cafile>
14163 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14164 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14165 server's certificate.
14166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014167check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014168 This option enables health checks on a server:
14169 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14170 considered available.
14171 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14172 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14173 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14174 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14175 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14176 set.
14177 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14178 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14179 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14180 exchanges succeed.
14181
14182 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14183 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14184 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14185 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14186 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014187 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014188 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14189
14190 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14191 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14192
14193 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14194 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14195
14196 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14197 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14198 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14199 available.
14200
14201 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14202 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14203 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14204
14205 Example:
14206 # simple tcp check
14207 backend foo
14208 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14209 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14210 backend foo
14211 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14212 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14213 backend foo
14214 option tcp-check
14215 tcp-check connect
14216 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014217
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014218check-send-proxy
14219 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14220 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14221 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14222 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14223 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14224 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14225 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14226
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014227check-alpn <protocols>
14228 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14229 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14230 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14231
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014232check-proto <name>
14233 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14234 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14235 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014236 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14237 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14238
14239 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14240 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14241 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14242 also reported (flag=HTX).
14243
14244 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14245 directive on a server line:
14246
14247 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14248 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14249 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14250 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14251
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014252 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014253 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14254 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14255
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014256check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014257 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014258 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14259 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014260
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014261check-ssl
14262 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14263 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14264 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14265 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014266 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014267 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14268 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014269 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014270 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14271 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014272
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014273check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014274 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014275 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14276 for normal traffic.
14277
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014278ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14280 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14281 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014282 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14283 information and recommendations see e.g.
14284 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14285 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14286 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014287
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014288ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14289 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14290 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14291 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14292 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014293 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14294 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14295 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014297cookie <value>
14298 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14299 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14300 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14301 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14302 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14303 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14304 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14305
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014306crl-file <crlfile>
14307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14308 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14309 to verify server's certificate.
14310
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014311crt <cert>
14312 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14313 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14314 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14315 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14316 certificate request.
14317
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014318 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14319 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14320 option is set accordingly).
14321
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014322disabled
14323 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14324 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14325 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14326 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14327 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014328 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014329
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014330enabled
14331 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14332 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14333 default value.
14334 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14335 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014336
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014337error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014338 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14339 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14340 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014342 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014343
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014344fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014345 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14346 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14347 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14348
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014349force-sslv3
14350 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14351 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014352 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014353 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014354
14355force-tlsv10
14356 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014357 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014358 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014359
14360force-tlsv11
14361 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014362 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014363 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014364
14365force-tlsv12
14366 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014367 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014368 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014369
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014370force-tlsv13
14371 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14372 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014373 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014375id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014376 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14377 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14378 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014379
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014380init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14381 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14382 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014383 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014384 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14385 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14386 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14387 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14388 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14389 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14390 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14391 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14392 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014394 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14395 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14396 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14397 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14398 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14399 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014400 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014401
14402 Example:
14403 defaults
14404 # never fail on address resolution
14405 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014407inter <delay>
14408fastinter <delay>
14409downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014410 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14411 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14412 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14413 between checks depending on the server state :
14414
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014415 Server state | Interval used
14416 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14417 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14418 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14419 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14420 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14421 or yet unchecked. |
14422 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14423 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14424 | "inter" otherwise.
14425 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014426
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014427 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14428 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14429 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14430 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014431 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14432 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14433 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14434 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14435 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014436
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014437log-proto <logproto>
14438 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14439 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14440 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14441 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014443maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014444 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14445 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014446 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14447 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014448 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14449 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14450 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14451 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14452
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014453 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14454 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14455 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14456 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14457 than 50 concurrent requests.
14458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014459maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014460 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14461 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14462 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14463 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014464 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14465 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14466 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14467 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14468 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14469 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14470 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014471
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014472max-reuse <count>
14473 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14474 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14475 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14476 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14477 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14478 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14479 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14480 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014482minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014483 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14484 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14485 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14486 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14487 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14488 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014489 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014490 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014491
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014492namespace <name>
14493 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14494 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14495 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14496 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14497
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014498no-agent-check
14499 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14500 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14501 default value.
14502 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14503 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14504
14505no-backup
14506 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14507 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14508 default value.
14509 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14510 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14511
14512no-check
14513 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14514 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14515 default value.
14516 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14517 "default-server" "check" setting.
14518
14519no-check-ssl
14520 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14521 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14522 default value.
14523 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14524 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14525
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014526no-send-proxy
14527 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14528 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14529 default value.
14530 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14531 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14532
14533no-send-proxy-v2
14534 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14535 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14536 default value.
14537 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14538 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14539
14540no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14541 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14542 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14543 default value.
14544 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14545 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14546
14547no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14548 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14549 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14550 default value.
14551 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14552 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14553
14554no-ssl
14555 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14556 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14557 default value.
14558 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14559 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14560
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014561 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14562 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14563 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14564
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014565no-ssl-reuse
14566 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14567 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14568 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14569 and for paranoid users.
14570
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014571no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014572 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14573 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014574 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014575
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014576 Supported in default-server: No
14577
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014578no-tls-tickets
14579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14580 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14581 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014582 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14583 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014584 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14585 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14586 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014587 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014588
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014589no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014590 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014591 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14592 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014593 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14594 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014595 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014596
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014597 Supported in default-server: No
14598
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014599no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014600 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014601 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14602 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014603 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14604 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014605 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014606
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014607 Supported in default-server: No
14608
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014609no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014610 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014611 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14612 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014613 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14614 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014615 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014616
14617 Supported in default-server: No
14618
14619no-tlsv13
14620 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14621 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14622 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14623 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14624 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014625 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014626
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014627 Supported in default-server: No
14628
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014629no-verifyhost
14630 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14631 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14632 default value.
14633 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14634 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014635
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014636no-tfo
14637 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14638 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14639 default value.
14640 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14641 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14642
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014643non-stick
14644 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14645 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14646 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14647
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014648npn <protocols>
14649 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14650 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14651 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014652 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014653 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14654 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14655 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014657observe <mode>
14658 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14659 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14660 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14661 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14662 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14663 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014664 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014665
14666 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14667
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014668on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014669 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14670 Currently, four modes are available:
14671 - fastinter: force fastinter
14672 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14673 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14674 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14675 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14676
14677 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14678
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014679on-marked-down <action>
14680 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14681 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014682 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14683 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14684 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14685 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14686 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14687 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14688 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14689 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014690
14691 Actions are disabled by default
14692
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014693on-marked-up <action>
14694 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14695 Currently one action is available:
14696 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14697 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14698 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14699 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014700 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14701 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014702 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14703 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14704
14705 Actions are disabled by default
14706
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014707pool-low-conn <max>
14708 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14709 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14710 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14711 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14712 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14713 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14714 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14715 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14716 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14717 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014718 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14719 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14720 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14721 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014722
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014723pool-max-conn <max>
14724 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14725 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14726 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14727 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14728 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14729 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14730
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014731pool-purge-delay <delay>
14732 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014733 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014734 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014735
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014736port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014737 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014738 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14739 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14740 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14741 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14742 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014743
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014744proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014745 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14746 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14747 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014748 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14749 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14750
14751 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14752 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14753 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14754 also reported (flag=HTX).
14755
14756 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14757 a server line :
14758
14759 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14760 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14761 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14762 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14763
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014764 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014765 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14766
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014767 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014769redir <prefix>
14770 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14771 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14772 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14773 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14774 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14775 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14776 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14777 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014778 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014779 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014780 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14781 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14782 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14783 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14784
14785 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014787rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014788 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14789 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14790 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14791
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014792resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14793 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14794 server.
14795
14796 Available options:
14797
14798 * allow-dup-ip
14799 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14800 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14801 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14802 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14803 For such case, simply enable this option.
14804 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14805
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014806 * ignore-weight
14807 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14808 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14809 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14810
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014811 * prevent-dup-ip
14812 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14813 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14814 same fqdn.
14815 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14816
14817 Example:
14818 backend b_myapp
14819 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14820 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14821 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14822
14823 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14824 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14825 it
14826 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14827 different address
14828
14829 Default value: not set
14830
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014831resolve-prefer <family>
14832 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14833 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14834 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14835 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14836
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014837 Default value: ipv6
14838
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014839 Example:
14840
14841 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014842
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014843resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014844 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014845 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014846 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014847 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14848 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014849 configured network, another address is selected.
14850
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014851 Example:
14852
14853 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014854
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014855resolvers <id>
14856 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14857 hostname.
14858
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014859 Example:
14860
14861 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014862
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014863 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014864
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014865send-proxy
14866 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14867 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14868 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14869 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014870 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14871 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14872 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14873 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014874 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014875 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14876 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14877 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14878 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14879 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014880 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14881 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014882
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014883send-proxy-v2
14884 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14885 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14886 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14887 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014888 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14889 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14890 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14891 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014892
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014893proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014894 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14895 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14896
14897 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14898 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14899 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14900 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14901 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14902 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14903 connection is supported).
14904 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14905 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14906 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14907 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14908 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14909 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14910 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014911
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014912send-proxy-v2-ssl
14913 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14914 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14915 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14916 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14917 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14918 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14919 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014920 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14921 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014922
14923send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14924 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14925 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14926 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14927 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14928 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14929 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14930 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14931 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014932 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14933 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014935slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014936 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14937 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14938 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14939 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14940 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14941 parameters :
14942
14943 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14944 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14945
14946 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14947 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14948 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14949 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14950
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014951 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014952 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14953 seen as failed.
14954
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014955sni <expression>
14956 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14957 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14958 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14959 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014960 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14961 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014962 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014963 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14964 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014965
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014966source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014967source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014968source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014969 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14970 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14971 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14972 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14973
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014974 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14975 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14976 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14977 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14978 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14979 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14980 server.
14981
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014982 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14983 specifying the source address without port(s).
14984
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014985ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014986 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14987 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14988 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14989 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14990 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14991 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014992 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14993 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014994
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014995ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14996 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14997 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14998 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14999
15000ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15001 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15002 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15003 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15004
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015005ssl-reuse
15006 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15007 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15008 default value.
15009 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15010 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15011
15012stick
15013 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15014 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15015 default value.
15016 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15017 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015018
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015019socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015020 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015021 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15022 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15023
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015024tcp-ut <delay>
15025 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015026 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015027 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015028 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015029 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15030 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15031 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15032 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15033 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15034 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15035 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15036 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15037 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15038
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015039tfo
15040 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15041 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15042 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15043 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015044 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015045 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015047track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015048 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15049 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15050 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15051 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015052 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15053
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015054tls-tickets
15055 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15056 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15057 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015058 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15059 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15060 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015061 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015062 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015063
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015064verify [none|required]
15065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015066 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015067 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15068 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015069 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015070 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15071 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15072 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15073 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15074 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15075 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15076 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15077 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015078
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015079verifyhost <hostname>
15080 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015081 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15082 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15083 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15084 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15085 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15086 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15087 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15088 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015090weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015091 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15092 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15093 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015094 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15095 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15096 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15097 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15098 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15099 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015100
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015101ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15102 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15103 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15104 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15105
15106 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15107 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15108 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15109 server ALPN contains it.
15110
15111 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15112 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15113 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15114 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15115
15116 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15117 favor of the ALPN extension.
15118
15119 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015121
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151225.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15123-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015124
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015125HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15126using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015127configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015128This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15129can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15130workload.
15131This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15132resolution at run time.
15133Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15134carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15135
15136
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151375.3.1. Global overview
15138----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015139
15140As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15141different steps of the process life:
15142
15143 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15144 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15145 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15146
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015147 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15148 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015149
15150A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15151 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15152 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15153 resolution to know this new IP.
15154
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015155When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015156HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015157SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15158from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015159will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015160will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015161
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015162A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015163 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015164 first valid response.
15165
15166 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15167 servers return an error.
15168
15169
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151705.3.2. The resolvers section
15171----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015172
15173This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015174HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15175contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015176
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015177When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15178uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15179is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15180answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15181
15182When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015183used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015184
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015185 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15186 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15187 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015188
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015189 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15190 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015191
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015192 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015193 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15194 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015195
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015196For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15197following scenarios are possible:
15198
15199 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15200 ignored
15201
15202 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15203 applied
15204
15205 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15206 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15207
15208 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15209 retries the query with a new type
15210
15211 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15212 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015213
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015214As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015215a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015216<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015217
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015218
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015219resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015220 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015221
15222A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15223
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015224accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015225 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015226 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015227 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15228 by RFC 6891)
15229
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015230 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15231 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15232 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15233 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15234 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15235 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015236
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015237nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15238 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15239 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15240 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15241 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15242 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15243 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15244 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15245 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15246 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015247 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15248
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015249parse-resolv-conf
15250 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15251 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15252 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15253
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015254hold <status> <period>
15255 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15256 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015257 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015258 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015259 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15260 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15261 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15262
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015263 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015264
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015265resolve_retries <nb>
15266 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15267 giving up.
15268 Default value: 3
15269
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015270 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15271 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15272 type.
15273
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015274timeout <event> <time>
15275 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15276 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15277 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015278 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15279 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015280 Default value: 1s
15281 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015282 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015283 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015284 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15285 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15286
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015287 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015288
15289 resolvers mydns
15290 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15291 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015292 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015293 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015294 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015295 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015296 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015297 hold other 30s
15298 hold refused 30s
15299 hold nx 30s
15300 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015301 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015302 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015303
15304
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153056. Cache
15306---------
15307
15308HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15309(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15310RAM.
15311
15312The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15313this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15314
15315If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15316independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15317when we try to allocate a new one.
15318
15319The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15320
15321It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15322"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15323for more details.
15324
15325When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15326replaced by "<CACHE>".
15327
15328
153296.1. Limitation
15330----------------
15331
15332The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15333
15334- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015335- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15336 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15337 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015338- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15339- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015340- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15341 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15342 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015343- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15344 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015345- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15346 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15347 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015348
15349- If the request is not a GET
15350- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15351- If the request contains an Authorization header
15352
15353
153546.2. Setup
15355-----------
15356
15357To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15358the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15359
15360
153616.2.1. Cache section
15362---------------------
15363
15364cache <name>
15365 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15366 size of cache is mandatory.
15367
15368total-max-size <megabytes>
15369 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15370 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15371
15372max-object-size <bytes>
15373 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15374 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15375 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15376
15377max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015378 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015379 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15380 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15381 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15382 default.
15383
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015384process-vary <on/off>
15385 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015386 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15387 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15388 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015389 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015390
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015391max-secondary-entries <number>
15392 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15393 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15394 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15395
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015396
153976.2.2. Proxy section
15398---------------------
15399
15400http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15401 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15402 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15403 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15404 after this one.
15405
15406http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15407 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15408 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15409 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15410 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15411
15412
15413Example:
15414
15415 backend bck1
15416 mode http
15417
15418 http-request cache-use foobar
15419 http-response cache-store foobar
15420 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15421
15422 cache foobar
15423 total-max-size 4
15424 max-age 240
15425
15426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154277. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15428----------------------------------
15429
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15432The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15433these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15434but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15435data called patterns.
15436
15437
154387.1. ACL basics
15439---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015440
15441The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15442content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15443from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15444simple :
15445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015446 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015447 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015448 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15449 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15452adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015453
15454In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015457
15458This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15459Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15460and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015461an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15462conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15463as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15464are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015465
15466ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15467'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15468which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15469
15470There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15471performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15474specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15475this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015476methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15477ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478
15479Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15480 - boolean
15481 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15482 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15483 - string
15484 - data block
15485
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015486Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15487converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15488would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15489The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15490which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15491
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015492Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15493keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15494fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15495which are summarized in the table below :
15496
15497 +---------------------+-----------------+
15498 | Sample or converter | Default |
15499 | output type | matching method |
15500 +---------------------+-----------------+
15501 | boolean | bool |
15502 +---------------------+-----------------+
15503 | integer | int |
15504 +---------------------+-----------------+
15505 | ip | ip |
15506 +---------------------+-----------------+
15507 | string | str |
15508 +---------------------+-----------------+
15509 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15510 +---------------------+-----------------+
15511
15512Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15513matching method, see below.
15514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015515The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15516 - boolean
15517 - integer or integer range
15518 - IP address / network
15519 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15520 - regular expression
15521 - hex block
15522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015523The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15524
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015525 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15526 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015528 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015529 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015530 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015531 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015533The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15534read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15535if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15536lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15537will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15538beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015539a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015540lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15541exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15542
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015543The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15544parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15545ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15546a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15547check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15548
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015549The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15550socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15551file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15554loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15555
15556 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15557
15558In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15559the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15560case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15561as well.
15562
15563The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15564sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15565do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15566methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15567is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015568obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15570default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15571that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15572string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15573
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015574The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15575By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15576string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15577resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015578server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015579waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015580flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15581function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15584sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15585be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015586
15587 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15588 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015589 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15590 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15591 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15592 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015593
15594 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15595 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015596 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015597
15598 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015600
15601 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015603
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015604 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015605 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15606
15607 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15608 binary or string samples.
15609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015610 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15611 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15614 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15615 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015617 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15618 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15621 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015623 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15624 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15627 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015628 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15631 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15632 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015633
15634For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15635request, it is possible to do :
15636
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015637 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015638
15639In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15640buffer, one would use the following acl :
15641
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015642 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015643
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015644On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15645possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15646
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015647 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15650criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15651method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15652to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15653criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15654the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015657the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15658For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15661 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15662 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15663 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015664
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015665
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015666The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15667types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15668combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15669brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15670default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015672 +-------------------------------------------------+
15673 | Input sample type |
15674 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015675 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15677 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15678 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015679 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015681 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015682 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015683 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015685 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015687 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015688 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015689 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015691 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015692 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015693 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015695 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015697 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015699 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15701 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15702 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015703
15704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157057.1.1. Matching booleans
15706------------------------
15707
15708In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15709Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15710When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15711that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15712
15713Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15714return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15715"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15716
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157187.1.2. Matching integers
15719------------------------
15720
15721Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15722enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15723to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15724
15725Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15726matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15727lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015728
15729For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15730unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15731representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15732
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015733As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15734two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15735instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15736ranges and operators.
15737
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015738For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015739operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15740Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15741of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015743Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015744
15745 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15746 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15747 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15748 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15749 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15750
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015751For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015752
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015753 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015754
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015755This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15756
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015757 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015758
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157607.1.3. Matching strings
15761-----------------------
15762
15763String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15764different forms :
15765
15766 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015767 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015768
15769 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771
15772 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15773 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15774
15775 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15776 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15777
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015778 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015779 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15780 matches.
15781
15782 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15783 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15784 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015785
15786String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15787exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15788characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15789string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15790to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015791before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015792
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015793Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15794(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15795Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15796
15797Example:
15798 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15799 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15800
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158027.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15803---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015804
15805Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15806they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15807possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15808passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15809the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015810the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15811match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015812
15813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158147.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15815-------------------------------------
15816
15817It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15818not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15819a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15820to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15821digits may be used upper or lower case.
15822
15823Example :
15824 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015825 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015826
15827
158287.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15829---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015830
15831IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15832netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15833within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015834host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015835difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15836at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15837does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15838parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015839
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015840The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15841abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15842
15843 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15844 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15845 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15846 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15847 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15848 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15849 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15850 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15851
15852Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15853192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15854
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015855IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15856Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15857trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15858IPv6 patterns.
15859
15860HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15861following situations :
15862 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15863 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15864 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15865 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15866 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15867 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15868 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15869 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15870 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15871 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015873
158747.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15875----------------------------------
15876
15877Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15878combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15879
15880 - AND (implicit)
15881 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15882 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015886 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015888Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15889indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15892"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15893requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15894is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15895
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015896 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015897 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15898 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15899 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900
15901To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15902and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15903
15904 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15905 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15906 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15907 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15908
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015909 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15911 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15912 use_backend www if host_www
15913
15914It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15915expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15916be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15917the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15918
15919 The following rule :
15920
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015921 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015922 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015923
15924 Can also be written that way :
15925
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015926 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015927
15928It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15929to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15930simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15931sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15932good use is the following :
15933
15934 With named ACLs :
15935
15936 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15937 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15938 monitor fail if site_dead
15939
15940 With anonymous ACLs :
15941
15942 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15943
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015944See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15945keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946
15947
159487.3. Fetching samples
15949---------------------
15950
15951Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15952against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15953sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15954ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15955of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15956available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15957
15958This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15959Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15960compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15961deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15962
15963The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15964matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15965method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15966indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15967
15968As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15969when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15970mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15971the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15972ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15973
15974Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15975multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15976when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015977incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15978are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15980all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15981
15982Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15983 - name
15984 - name(arg1)
15985 - name(arg1,arg2)
15986
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015987
159887.3.1. Converters
15989-----------------
15990
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015991Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15992of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15993is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15994was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015995has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015996unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15997
15998These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15999sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16000the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016001support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016003A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16004support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16005supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16006(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16007bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016010
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001601151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16012 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16013 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16014 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16015 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16016 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16017
16018 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016019 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16020 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016021 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16022 frontend http-in
16023 bind *:8081
16024 default_backend servers
16025 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16026 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16027
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016028add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016029 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016030 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016031 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16032 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016033 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016034 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16035 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16036 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16037 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016038 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016039 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016040
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016041aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16042 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16043 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16044 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16045 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16046 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16047 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16048
16049 Example:
16050 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16051 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16052
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016053and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016054 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016055 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016056 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16057 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016058 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016059 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16060 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16061 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16062 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016063 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016064 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016065
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016066b64dec
16067 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16068 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016069 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16070 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016071
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016072base64
16073 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016074 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016075 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16076 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016077
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016078bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016079 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016080 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016081 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016082 presence of a flag).
16083
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016084bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16085 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16086 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016087 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016088
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016089concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16090 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16091 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16092 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16093 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16094 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16095 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16096 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16097 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16098 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16099 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016100 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016101 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016102 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16103 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016104
16105 Example:
16106 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16107 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16108 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016109 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016110 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16111
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016112cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016113 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16114 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016115
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016116crc32([<avalanche>])
16117 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16118 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16119 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16120 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16121 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16122 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16123 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16124 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16125 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16126 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016127 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16128
16129crc32c([<avalanche>])
16130 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16131 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16132 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16133 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16134 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16135 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16136 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16137 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016138
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016139cut_crlf
16140 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16141 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16142 updated.
16143
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016144da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016145 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16146 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16147 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16148 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016149 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016150 configuration language.
16151
16152 Example:
16153 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016154 bind *:8881
16155 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016156 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016157
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016158debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16159 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16160 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16161 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16162 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16163 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16164 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16165 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16166 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16167 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16168 printable sample types.
16169
16170 Example:
16171 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016172
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016173digest(<algorithm>)
16174 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16175 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16176
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016177 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016178 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16179
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016180div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016181 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16182 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016183 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016184 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16185 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016186 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016187 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16188 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16189 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16190 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016191 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016192 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016193
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016194djb2([<avalanche>])
16195 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16196 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16197 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16198 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16199 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16200 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16201 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016202 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16203 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016204
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016205even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016206 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016207 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16208
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016209field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16210 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16211 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16212 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16213 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16214 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16215 fields.
16216
16217 Example :
16218 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16219 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16220 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16221 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16222 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016223
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016224fix_is_valid
16225 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16226 Information eXchange):
16227
16228 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16229 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016230 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016231 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016232 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016233 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16234 checksum
16235
16236 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16237 the server can be parsed.
16238
16239 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16240 message, false if not.
16241
16242 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16243
16244 Example:
16245 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16246 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16247
16248fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16249 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16250 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16251 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16252 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016253 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016254 added.
16255
16256 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16257 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16258 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16259 fix_is_valid converter.
16260
16261 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16262
16263 Example:
16264 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16265 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16266 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16267 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16268 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16269
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016270hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016271 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016272 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016273 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016274 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016275
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016276hex2i
16277 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016278 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016279
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016280htonl
16281 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16282 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16283 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16284 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16285
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016286hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016287 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16288 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16289 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16290 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016292 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016293 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16294
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016295http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016296 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16297 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016298 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16299 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16300 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16301 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16302 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16303 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16304 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16305 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016307iif(<true>,<false>)
16308 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16309 string otherwise.
16310
16311 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016312 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016313
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016314in_table(<table>)
16315 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16316 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16317 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016318 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016319 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16320
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016321ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016322 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016323 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016324 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16325 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16326 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16327 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16328 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016329
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016330json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016331 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016332 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016333 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016334 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16335 of errors:
16336 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16337 bytes, ...)
16338 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16339 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16340
16341 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16342 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16343 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16344 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16345 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16346 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016347 - "ascii" : never fails;
16348 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16349 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016350 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016351 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016352 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16353 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16354
16355 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016357
16358 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016359 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016360 capture request header user-agent len 150
16361 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016362
16363 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16364 GET / HTTP/1.0
16365 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16366
16367 Output log:
16368 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16369
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016370json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16371 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16372 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16373 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16374 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16375
16376 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16377 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16378
16379 Example:
16380 # get a integer value from the request body
16381 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16382 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16383
16384 # get a key with '.' in the name
16385 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16386 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16387
16388 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16389 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16390
16391 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16392 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16393
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016394language(<value>[,<default>])
16395 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16396 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16397 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16398 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16399 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16400 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16401 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16402 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16403 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016404 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016405 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16406 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016408 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016409
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016410 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16411 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016413 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16414 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16415 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16416 use_backend spanish if es
16417 use_backend french if fr
16418 use_backend english if en
16419 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016420
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016421length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016422 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16423 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16424 type. The result is of type integer.
16425
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016426lower
16427 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16428 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16429 type. The result is of type string.
16430
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016431ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16432 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16433 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16434 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16435 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16436 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16437 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16438
16439 Example :
16440
16441 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016443 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16444
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016445ltrim(<chars>)
16446 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16447 representation of the input sample.
16448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016449map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16450map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16451map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16452 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16453 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16454 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16455 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16456 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16457 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16458 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16459 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016460
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016461 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16462 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16463 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016464
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016465 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016466 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016467
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016468 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16470 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016472 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016474 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16476 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16478 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16480 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016482 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16484 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016485 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16486 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16488 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016490
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016491 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16492 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16493 the corresponding match text.
16494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016495 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16496 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16497 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16498 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16499 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016501 Example :
16502
16503 # this is a comment and is ignored
16504 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16505 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16506 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16507 | | | `---------- value
16508 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16509 | `---------------------------- key
16510 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16511
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016512mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016513 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16514 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016515 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016516 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016517 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016518 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16519 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16520 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16521 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016522 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016523 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016524
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016525mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016526 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16527 <packettype>.
16528 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16529 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16530 from.
16531 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16532 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16533 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16534
16535 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16536 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16537 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16538 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16539
16540 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16541 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16542 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16543 packets only):
16544 17: Session Expiry Interval
16545 33: Receive Maximum
16546 39: Maximum Packet Size
16547 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16548 25: Request Response Information
16549 23: Request Problem Information
16550 21: Authentication Method
16551 22: Authentication Data
16552 18: Will Delay Interval
16553 1: Payload Format Indicator
16554 2: Message Expiry Interval
16555 3: Content Type
16556 8: Response Topic
16557 9: Correlation Data
16558 Not supported yet:
16559 38: User Property
16560
16561 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16562 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16563 packets only):
16564 17: Session Expiry Interval
16565 33: Receive Maximum
16566 36: Maximum QoS
16567 37: Retain Available
16568 39: Maximum Packet Size
16569 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16570 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16571 31: Reason String
16572 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16573 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16574 42: Shared Subscription Available
16575 19: Server Keep Alive
16576 26: Response Information
16577 28: Server Reference
16578 21: Authentication Method
16579 22: Authentication Data
16580 Not supported yet:
16581 38: User Property
16582
16583 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16584 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16585 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16586 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16587
16588 Example:
16589
16590 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16591 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16592 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16593 if data_in_buffer
16594 # do the same as above
16595 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16596 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16597 if data_in_buffer
16598
16599mqtt_is_valid
16600 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16601
16602 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16603 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16604 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16605 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16606
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016607 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16608
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016609 Example:
16610
16611 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016612 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016613
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016614mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016615 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016616 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16617 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016618 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016619 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016627
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016628nbsrv
16629 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16630 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16631 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16632 map lookup.
16633
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016634neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016635 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16636 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16637 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16638 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016639
16640not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016641 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016642 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016643 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016644 absence of a flag).
16645
16646odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016647 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016648 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16649
16650or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016651 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016652 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016653 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16654 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016662
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016663protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16664 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16665 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16666 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16667 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16668 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16669 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16670 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16671 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16672 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16673 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16674 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16675
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016676regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016677 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16678 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16679 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16680 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16681 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16682 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16683 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16684 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16685 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016686 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16687 of characters with other ones.
16688
16689 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16690 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16691 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16692 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16693 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16694 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016695
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016696 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016697
16698 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16699 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16700 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016701 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016702
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016703 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16704 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16705
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016706 # capture groups and backreferences
16707 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016708 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016709 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16710
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016711capture-req(<id>)
16712 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16713 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16714
16715 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016716 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16717 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016718
16719capture-res(<id>)
16720 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16721 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16722
16723 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016724 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16725 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016726
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016727rtrim(<chars>)
16728 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16729 of the input sample.
16730
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016731sdbm([<avalanche>])
16732 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16733 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16734 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16735 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16736 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16737 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16738 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016739 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16740 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016741
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016742secure_memcmp(<var>)
16743 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16744 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16745 match.
16746
16747 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16748 performed in constant time.
16749
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016750 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016751 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16752
16753 Example :
16754
16755 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16756 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16757 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16758 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16759
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016760set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016761 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16762 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16763 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016764 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016765 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16766 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016767 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016768 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16769 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016770 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016771 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016772
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016773sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016774 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016775 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16776
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016777sha2([<bits>])
16778 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16779 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16780
16781 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16782 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16783
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016784 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016785 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16786
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016787srv_queue
16788 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16789 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16790 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16791 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16792 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16793
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016794strcmp(<var>)
16795 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16796 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16797 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16798 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16799 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16800 shorter).
16801
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016802 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16803 strings in constant time.
16804
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016805 Example :
16806
16807 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16808 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16809 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16810
16811
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016812sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016813 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16814 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016815 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016816 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16817 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016818 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016819 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16820 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016821 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016822 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16823 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016824 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016825 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016826
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016827table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16831 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16832 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16833 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16834
16835
16836table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16839 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16840 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16841 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16842 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16843
16844table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16845 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16846 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016847 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016848 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16849 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16850
16851table_conn_cur(<table>)
16852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16855 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16856 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16857
16858table_conn_rate(<table>)
16859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16862 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16863 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16864
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016865table_gpt0(<table>)
16866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16869 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16870 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16871
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016872table_gpc0(<table>)
16873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16876 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16877 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16878
16879table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16883 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16884 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16885 sample fetch keyword.
16886
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016887table_gpc1(<table>)
16888 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16889 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16890 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16891 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16892 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16893
16894table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16895 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16896 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16897 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16898 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16899 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16900 sample fetch keyword.
16901
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016902table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16903 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16904 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016905 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016906 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16907 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16908
16909table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16912 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16913 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16914 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16915 keyword.
16916
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016917table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16921 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16922 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16923
16924table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16927 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16928 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16929 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16930 keyword.
16931
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016932table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016936 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16937 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16938
16939table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16940 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16941 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16942 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16943 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16944 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16945 keyword.
16946
16947table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016950 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016951 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16952 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16953 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16954 keyword.
16955
16956table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16957 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16958 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016959 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016960 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16961 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16962 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16963 keyword.
16964
16965table_server_id(<table>)
16966 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16967 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16968 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16969 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16970 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16971 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16972
16973table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016976 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016977 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16978 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16979 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16980 keyword.
16981
16982table_sess_rate(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16986 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16987 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16988 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16989 keyword.
16990
16991table_trackers(<table>)
16992 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16993 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16994 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16995 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16996 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16997 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16998 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16999 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17000 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17001 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17002
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017003ub64dec
17004 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17005 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17006 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17007
17008 Example:
17009 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17010 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17011
17012ub64enc
17013 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17014
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017015upper
17016 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17017 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17018 type. The result is of type string.
17019
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017020url_dec([<in_form>])
17021 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17022 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17023 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17024 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17025 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17026 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017027
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017028url_enc([<enc_type>])
17029 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17030 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17031 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17032 optional argument is here for future changes.
17033
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017034ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017035 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017036 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17037 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17038 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017039 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17040 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17041 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17042 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017043 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017044 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17045 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017046
17047 Example:
17048 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17049 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17050
17051 message Point {
17052 int32 latitude = 1;
17053 int32 longitude = 2;
17054 }
17055
17056 message PPoint {
17057 Point point = 59;
17058 }
17059
17060 message Rectangle {
17061 // One corner of the rectangle.
17062 PPoint lo = 48;
17063 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17064 PPoint hi = 49;
17065 }
17066
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017067 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17068 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17069 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017070
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017071 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17072 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017073 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017074 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17075
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017076 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017077
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017078 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017079
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017080 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17081 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17082 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017083
17084 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17085 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17086 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17087
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017088 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17089 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17090 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017091
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017092
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017093unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017094 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17095 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17096 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17097 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17098 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17099 response),
17100 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17101 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17102 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17103 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17104
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017105utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17106 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17107 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17108 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17109 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17110 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17111 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17112
17113 Example :
17114
17115 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017116 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017117 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17118
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017119word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17120 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17121 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17122 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017123 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017124 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17125 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17126
17127 Example :
17128 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17129 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17130 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17131 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17132 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017133 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017134
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017135wt6([<avalanche>])
17136 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17137 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17138 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17139 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17140 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17141 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17142 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017143 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17144 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017145
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017146xor(<value>)
17147 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017148 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017149 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017150 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017151 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017152 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17153 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017154 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017155 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17156 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017157 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017158 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017159
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017160xxh3([<seed>])
17161 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17162 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17163 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17164 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17165 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17166 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17167 considered as cryptographically secure.
17168
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017169xxh32([<seed>])
17170 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17171 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17172 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17173 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17174 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17175 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17176 as cryptographically secure.
17177
17178xxh64([<seed>])
17179 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17180 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17181 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17182 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17183 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17184 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17185 as cryptographically secure.
17186
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017187
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017189--------------------------------------------
17190
17191A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17192not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17193"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17194The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17195
17196always_false : boolean
17197 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17198 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17199
17200always_true : boolean
17201 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17202 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17203
17204avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017205 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017206 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17207 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17208 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17209 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17210 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17211 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17212 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17213 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17214 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17215 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17216 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17217 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17218 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017221 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17222 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17223 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17224 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017225 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17226
17227be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17229 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17230 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17231 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17232 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017233 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17234 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017235
17236 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17237 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17238 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017240be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17242 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17243 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017244 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017245 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17246 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017247
17248 Example :
17249 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17250 backend dynamic
17251 mode http
17252 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17253 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017254
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017255bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017256 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17257 of the string.
17258
17259bool(<bool>) : bool
17260 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17261 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17264 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017265 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017266 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17267 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017268
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017269 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017270 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017271 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17272
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017273 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17274 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017275
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017276 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017277 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017278 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017279 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017280 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017282 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017283
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017284 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17285 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017286 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017287 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017288
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017289cpu_calls : integer
17290 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17291 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17292 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17293 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17294 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17295 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17296
17297cpu_ns_avg : integer
17298 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17299 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17300 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17301 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17302 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17303 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17304 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17305 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17306 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17307 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17308 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17309
17310cpu_ns_tot : integer
17311 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17312 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17313 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17314 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17315 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17316 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17317 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17318 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17319 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17320 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17321 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17322 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17323 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17324
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017325date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017326 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017327
17328 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17329 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17330 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017331 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17332
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017333 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17334 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17335 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17336 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17337 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17338
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017339 Example :
17340
17341 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17342 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017343
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017344 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17345 # millisecond granularity
17346 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17347
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017348date_us : integer
17349 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17350 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17351 from the same timeval structure.
17352
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017353distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17354 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17355 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17356 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17357 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017358 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017359 list of supported tokens.
17360
17361distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17362 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17363 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17364 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17365 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017366 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017367 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17368 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17369 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17370 supported tokens.
17371
17372 Example :
17373 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17374 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17375 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17376 # send large files to the big farm
17377 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17378
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017379env(<name>) : string
17380 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17381 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17382 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17383 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17384 certain way.
17385
17386 Examples :
17387 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17388 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17389
17390 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017391 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017393fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17394 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017395 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17396 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017397 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17398 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017399 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017400 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17401 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017402
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017403fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17405 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17406 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017408fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17409 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17410 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17411 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17412 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17413 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17414 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17415 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17416 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017417
17418 Example :
17419 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17420 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17421 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17422 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17423 frontend mail
17424 bind :25
17425 mode tcp
17426 maxconn 100
17427 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17428 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17429 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17430 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017431
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017432hostname : string
17433 Returns the system hostname.
17434
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017435int(<integer>) : signed integer
17436 Returns a signed integer.
17437
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017438ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17439 Returns an ipv4.
17440
17441ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17442 Returns an ipv6.
17443
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017444lat_ns_avg : integer
17445 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17446 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17447 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17448 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17449 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17450 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17451 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17452 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17453 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017454 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17455 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17456 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17457 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17458 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17459 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017460
17461lat_ns_tot : integer
17462 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17463 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17464 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17465 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17466 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17467 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17468 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17469 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17470 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017471 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17472 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17473 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17474 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17475 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017476 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17477 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17478 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17479 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17480 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17481 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17482
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017483meth(<method>) : method
17484 Returns a method.
17485
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017486nbproc : integer
17487 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17488 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17489 and debugging purposes.
17490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017491nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17493 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17494 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017495 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17496 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17497 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017498
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017499prio_class : integer
17500 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17501 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17502 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17503
17504prio_offset : integer
17505 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17506 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17507 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17508 set-priority-offset".
17509
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017510proc : integer
17511 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17512 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17513 debugging purposes.
17514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017515queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017516 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17517 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17518 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017519 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17520 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17521 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17522 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17523 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17524
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017525rand([<range>]) : integer
17526 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17527 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17528 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17529 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17530 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017532srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17533 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17534 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17535 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17536 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17537 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017538 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17539 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17540
17541srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17543 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17544 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17545 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17546 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17547 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17548 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17549
17550 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17551 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552
17553srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17554 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17555 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17556 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017557 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017558 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17559 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17560 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17561
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017562srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17563 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17564 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17565 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17566 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17567 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17568 fetch methods.
17569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17571 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17572 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017573 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017574 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17575 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017576 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017577 overloading servers).
17578
17579 Example :
17580 # Redirect to a separate back
17581 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17582 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17583 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17584
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017585srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017586 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17587 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17588 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17589
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017590srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017591 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17592 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17593 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17594
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017595srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017596 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17597 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17598 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17599
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017600stopping : boolean
17601 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17602 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17603 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17604
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017605str(<string>) : string
17606 Returns a string.
17607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17609 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17610 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17611
17612table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17613 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17614 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17615 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17616
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017617thread : integer
17618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17619 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17620 and debugging purposes.
17621
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017622uuid([<version>]) : string
17623 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17624 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17625 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17626
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017627var(<var-name>) : undefined
17628 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017629 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17630 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017631 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017632 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17633 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017634 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017635 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17636 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017638 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017639
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017641----------------------------------
17642
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017643The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017644closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17645methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17646sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17647TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017648the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17649counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017650"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17651used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17652can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17653Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17654table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17655tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17656currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017657
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017658bc_dst : ip
17659 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17660 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17661 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17662 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17663
17664bc_dst_port : integer
17665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017666 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017667
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017668bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017669 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17670 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17671 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17672
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017673bc_src : ip
17674 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017675 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017676 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17677 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17678
17679bc_src_port : integer
17680 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017681 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017683be_id : integer
17684 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017685 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17686 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017688be_name : string
17689 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017690 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17691 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017692
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017693be_server_timeout : integer
17694 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17695 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17696 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17697
17698be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17699 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17700 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17701 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17702
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017703cur_server_timeout : integer
17704 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17705 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17706 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17707
17708cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17709 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17710 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17711 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713dst : ip
17714 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17715 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17716 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17717 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017718 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17719 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17720 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17721 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17722 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17723 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017724
17725dst_conn : integer
17726 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17727 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17728 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17729 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17730 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17731 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17732 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17733 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017734
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017735dst_is_local : boolean
17736 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17737 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17738 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17739 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017740 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017741 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17742 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17743 it only once per connection.
17744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745dst_port : integer
17746 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17747 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17748 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17749 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17750 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17751 an HTTP header.
17752
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017753fc_fackets : integer
17754 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17755 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17756 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17757 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17758
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017759fc_http_major : integer
17760 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17761 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17762 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17763
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017764fc_lost : integer
17765 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17766 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17767 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17768 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17769
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017770fc_pp_authority : string
17771 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17772 if any.
17773
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017774fc_pp_unique_id : string
17775 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17776 if any.
17777
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017778fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17779 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17780 header.
17781
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017782fc_reordering : integer
17783 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17784 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17785 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17786 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17787
17788fc_retrans : integer
17789 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17790 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17791 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17792 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17793
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017794fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17795 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17796 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17797 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17798 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17799 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17800 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17801
17802fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17803 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17804 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17805 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17806 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17807 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17808 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17809
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017810fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017811 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17812 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17813 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17814 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17815
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017816
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017817fc_unacked : integer
17818 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17819 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17820 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17821 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017822
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017823fe_defbe : string
17824 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17825 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827fe_id : integer
17828 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017829 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17831
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017832fe_name : string
17833 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17834 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17835 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17836
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017837fe_client_timeout : integer
17838 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17839 current frontend.
17840
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017841sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017842sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17843sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17844sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017845 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17846 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17847 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017849sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017850sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17851sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17852sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017853 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17854 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17855 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17856
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017857sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017858sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17859sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17860sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017861 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17862 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017863 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17864 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17865 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017866
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017867 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017868 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17869 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017870 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17871 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17872 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017873 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17874 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17875
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017876sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17877sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17878sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17879sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17880 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17881 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17882 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17883 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17884 when a first ACL was verified.
17885
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017886sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017887sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17888sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17889sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017890 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017891 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17892
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017893sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017894sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17895sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17896sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017897 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17898 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17899 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017901sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017902sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17903sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17904sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017905 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17906 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17907 See also src_conn_rate.
17908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017909sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017910sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17911sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17912sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017913 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017914 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017915
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017916sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17917sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17918sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17919sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17920 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17921 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17922
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017923sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17924sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17925sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17926sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17927 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17928 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017930sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017931sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17932sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17933sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017934 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17935 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17936 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017937 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17938 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17939 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017941sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17942sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17943sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17944sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17945 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17946 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17947 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17948 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17949 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17950 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17951
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017952sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017953sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17954sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17955sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017956 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017957 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17958 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17959
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017960sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017961sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17962sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17963sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017964 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17965 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17966 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17967 src_http_err_rate.
17968
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017969sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17970sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17971sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17972sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17973 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17974 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17975 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17976
17977sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17978sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17979sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17980sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17981 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17982 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17983 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17984 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17985
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017986sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017987sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17988sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17989sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017990 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017991 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17992 src_http_req_cnt.
17993
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017994sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017995sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17996sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17997sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017998 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17999 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18000 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18001 src_http_req_rate.
18002
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018003sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018004sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18005sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18006sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018007 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018008 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18009 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18010 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18011 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018012
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018013 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018014 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18015 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018016 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18017
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018018sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18019sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18020sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18021sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18022 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18023 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18024 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18025 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18026 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18027
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018028sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018029sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18030sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18031sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018032 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18033 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18034 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018035
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018036sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018037sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18038sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18039sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018040 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18041 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18042 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018043
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018044sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018045sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18046sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18047sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018048 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018049 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18050 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18051 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018052 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018053 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18054
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018055sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018056sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18057sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18058sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018059 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18060 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18061 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18062 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18063 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018064 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018066sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018067sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18068sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18069sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018070 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18071 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18072 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018074sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018075sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18076sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18077sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018078 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18079 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018080 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018081 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18082 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18084 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18085 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018087so_id : integer
18088 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18089 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18090 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018091
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018092so_name : string
18093 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18094 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18095 strings instead of integers.
18096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018097src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018098 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018099 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18100 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18101 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018102 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18103 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18104 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018105 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18106 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18107 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18108 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18109 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18110 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18111 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018112
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018113 Example:
18114 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18115 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018117src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18118 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18119 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18120 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018121 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18124 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18125 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018126 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018127 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018129src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18130 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18131 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18132 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18133 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18134 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18135 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018136
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018137 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018138 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18139 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18140 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18141 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018142 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018143 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18144 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18145
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018146src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18147 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18148 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18149 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18150 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18151 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18152 was verified.
18153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018154src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018155 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018157 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018158 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018160src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018161 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18163 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018164 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18167 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18168 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18169 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018170 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018172src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018173 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018174 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018175 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018176 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018177
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018178src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18179 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18180 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18181 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18182 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18183
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018184src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18185 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18186 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18187 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18188 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018190src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018191 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18194 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018195 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18196 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18197 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018198
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018199src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18200 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18201 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18202 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18203 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18204 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18205 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18206 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018209 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018211 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018212 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018213 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18216 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18217 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18218 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18219 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018220 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018221
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018222src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18223 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18224 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018225 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018226 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18227 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18228
18229src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18230 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18231 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18232 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18233 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18234 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18235 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018238 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18240 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018241 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018243src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18244 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18245 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18246 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018247 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018248 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18251 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18252 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18253 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018254 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18256 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018257
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018258 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018259 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018260 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018261 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018262
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018263src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18264 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18265 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18266 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18267 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18268 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18269 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18270
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018271src_is_local : boolean
18272 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18273 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18274 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18275 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018276 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018277 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18278 once per connection.
18279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018281 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18282 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18283 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18284 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18285 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018287src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018288 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18289 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18290 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18291 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18292 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018294src_port : integer
18295 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18296 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18297 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18298 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018300src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018301 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018302 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18303 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18304 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018305 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018307src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18308 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18309 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18310 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18311 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018312 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018314src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18315 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18316 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18317 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18318 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18319 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18320 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18321 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18322 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018323
18324 Example :
18325 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18326 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18327 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18328 listen ssh
18329 bind :22
18330 mode tcp
18331 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018332 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018333 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018334 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336srv_id : integer
18337 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18338 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018339 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018340
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018341srv_name : string
18342 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18343 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018344 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018345
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183467.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018347----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018349The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18351when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18352usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018353future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018354
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001835551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18356 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18357 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18358 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18359 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18360 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18361
18362 Example :
18363 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18364 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18365 # the request.
18366 frontend http-in
18367 bind *:8081
18368 default_backend servers
18369 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18370 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18371
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018372ssl_bc : boolean
18373 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18374 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018375 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18376 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018377
18378ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18379 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018380 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18381 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018382
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018383ssl_bc_alpn : string
18384 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18385 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018386 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018387 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18388 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18389 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18390 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18391 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018392 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18393 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018394
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018395ssl_bc_cipher : string
18396 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018397 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18398 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018399
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018400ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18401 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18402 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18403 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018404 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018405
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018406ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18407 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18408 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018409 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18410 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018411
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018412ssl_bc_npn : string
18413 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18414 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018415 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018416 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18417 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18418 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18419 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018420 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18421 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018422
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018423ssl_bc_protocol : string
18424 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018425 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18426 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018427
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018428ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018429 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018430 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018431 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18432 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018433
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018434ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18435 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18436 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18437 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018438 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018439
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018440ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18441 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18442 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018443 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18444 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018445
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018446ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18447 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18448 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18449 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018450 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018451
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018452ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18453 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018454 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18455 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018457ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18458 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18459 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18460 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18461 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18462 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018464ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18465 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18466 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18467 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18468 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018469
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018470ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018471 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18472 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18473 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018474 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018475 does not support resumed sessions.
18476
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018477ssl_c_der : binary
18478 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18479 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18480 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018482ssl_c_err : integer
18483 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18484 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18485 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18486 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18487 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018488
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018489ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018490 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18491 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18492 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18493 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18494 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18495 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18496 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18497 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018498 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18499 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18500 LDAP v3.
18501 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18502 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018504ssl_c_key_alg : string
18505 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18506 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18507 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018509ssl_c_notafter : string
18510 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18511 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18512 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018514ssl_c_notbefore : string
18515 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18516 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18517 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018518
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018519ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18521 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18522 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18523 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18524 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18525 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18526 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18527 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018528 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18529 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18530 LDAP v3.
18531 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18532 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018534ssl_c_serial : binary
18535 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18536 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18537 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18540 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18541 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18542 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018543 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18544 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18545
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018546 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018547 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018549ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18550 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18551 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18552 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018554ssl_c_used : boolean
18555 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18556 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018558ssl_c_verify : integer
18559 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18560 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18561 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18562 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018564ssl_c_version : integer
18565 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18566 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018567
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018568ssl_f_der : binary
18569 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18570 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18571 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18572
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018573ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018574 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18575 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18576 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18577 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018578 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18580 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18581 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018582 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18583 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18584 LDAP v3.
18585 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18586 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018588ssl_f_key_alg : string
18589 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18590 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18591 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018593ssl_f_notafter : string
18594 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18595 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18596 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018598ssl_f_notbefore : string
18599 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18600 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18601 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018602
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018603ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18605 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18606 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18607 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18608 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18609 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18610 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18611 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018612 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18613 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18614 LDAP v3.
18615 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18616 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018618ssl_f_serial : binary
18619 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18620 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18621 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018622
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018623ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18624 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18625 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18626 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018628ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18629 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18630 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18631 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633ssl_f_version : integer
18634 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18635 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18636
18637ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018638 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18639 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18640 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018642 Example :
18643 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18644 listen http-https
18645 bind :80
18646 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18647 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18648
18649ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18650 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18651 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18652
18653ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018654 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018655 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018656 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018657 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18658 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18659 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18660 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18661 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18662 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664ssl_fc_cipher : string
18665 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18666 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018667
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018668ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18669 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18670 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018671 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018672
18673ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18674 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18675 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018676 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018677
18678ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18679 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18680 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18681 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018682 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018683 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018684
18685ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18686 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18687 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018688 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018689
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018690ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18691 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18692 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18693 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18694
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018695ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18696 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18697 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18698 transport layer.
18699 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18700 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18701 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18702 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18703
18704ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18705 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18706 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18707 transport layer.
18708 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18709 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18710 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18711 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18712
18713ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18714 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18715 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18716 transport layer.
18717 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18718 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18719 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18720 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18721
18722ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18723 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18724 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18725 transport layer.
18726 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18727 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18728 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18729 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18730
18731ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18732 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18733 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18734 transport layer.
18735 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18736 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18737 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18738 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018740ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018741 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18742 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018743 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18744 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18745 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18746 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018747
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018748ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18749 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18750 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18751 wait until the handshake happened.
18752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018753ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18754 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018755 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18756 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018757 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018758 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018759
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018760ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018761 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018762 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18763 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018765ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018766 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018767 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18769 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18770 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18771 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18772 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18773 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018775ssl_fc_protocol : string
18776 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18777 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018778
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018779ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018780 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018781 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018782 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018783
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018784ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18785 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18786 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18787 transport layer.
18788 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18789 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18790 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18791 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18792
18793ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18794 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18795 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18796 transport layer.
18797 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18798 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18799 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18800 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18801
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018802ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18803 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18804 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18805 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18808 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18809 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18810 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18811 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018812
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018813ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18814 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18815 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18816 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18817 BoringSSL.
18818
18819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820ssl_fc_sni : string
18821 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18822 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018823 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018824 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18825 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18826
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018827 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018828 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018829 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018830 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018831 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18835 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18838 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18839 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018840
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018841ssl_s_der : binary
18842 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18843 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18844 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18845
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018846ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18847 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18848 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18849 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018850 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018851 does not support resumed sessions.
18852
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018853ssl_s_key_alg : string
18854 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18855 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18856 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18857
18858ssl_s_notafter : string
18859 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18860 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18861 transport layer.
18862
18863ssl_s_notbefore : string
18864 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18865 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18866 transport layer.
18867
18868ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18869 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18870 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18871 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18872 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18873 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18874 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018875 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18876 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018877 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18878 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18879 LDAP v3.
18880 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18881 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18882
18883ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18884 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18885 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18886 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18887 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18888 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18889 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018890 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18891 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018892 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18893 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18894 LDAP v3.
18895 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18896 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18897
18898ssl_s_serial : binary
18899 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18900 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18901 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18902
18903ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18904 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18905 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18906 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18907
18908ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18909 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18910 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18911 layer.
18912
18913ssl_s_version : integer
18914 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18915 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018916
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189177.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018918------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018920Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18921sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18922only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18923For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18924be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18925can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18926sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18927for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18928content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018929
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018930Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18931 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018932 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018933 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18934 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18935 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18936 sample expression). So be careful.
18937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018939 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018940 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18941 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018943payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18944 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018945 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018946 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948req.len : integer
18949req_len : integer (deprecated)
18950 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18951 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18952 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18953 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18954 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018955 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18957 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018959req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18960 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018961 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18962 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18963 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18964 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018965
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018966 ACL derivatives :
18967 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18970 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18971 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18972 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18973 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018974
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018975 ACL derivatives :
18976 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018980req.proto_http : boolean
18981req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18982 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18983 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18984 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18985 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18986 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18987 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18988 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990 Example:
18991 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18992 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18993 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018994 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18997rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18998 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18999 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19000 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19001 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19002 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19003 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19004 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019006 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19007 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19008 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19009 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19010 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19011 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019014 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019016 Example :
19017 listen tse-farm
19018 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19019 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19020 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19021 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19022 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19023 persist rdp-cookie
19024 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19025 # This is only useful makes sense if
19026 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19027 stick-table type string size 204800
19028 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19029 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19030 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019032 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019033 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019035req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19036rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19037 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19038 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19039 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19040 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019042 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019043 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019044
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019045req.ssl_alpn : string
19046 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19047 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19048 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19049 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19050 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19051 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019052 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019053
19054 Examples :
19055 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19056 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019057 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019058 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019059 default_backend bk_default
19060
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019061req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19062 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19063 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019064 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19065 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19066 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19067 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19068 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19071req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19072 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19073 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19074 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19075 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19076 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19077 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19078 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080req.ssl_sni : string
19081req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19082 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19083 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19084 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19085 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19086 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019087 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19088 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19089 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19090 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19091 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19092 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19093 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19094 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19095 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019097 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019098 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019100 Examples :
19101 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19102 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019103 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019104 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019105 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019106
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019107req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19108 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19109 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19110 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19111 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19112 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19113 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19114 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19115 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19116 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118req.ssl_ver : integer
19119req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19120 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19121 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19122 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19123 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19124 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19125 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19126 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019127 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019130 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019131 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019132
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019133res.len : integer
19134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19135 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19136 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19137 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19138 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019139 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019140 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019141 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19144 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019145 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019146 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019147 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019148 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019150res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19151 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19152 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19153 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019154 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19155 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019158
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019159res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19160rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19161 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19162 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19163 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19164 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19165 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19166 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19167 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019169wait_end : boolean
19170 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19171 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019172 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19174 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019175 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019176 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19177 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019179 Examples :
19180 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19181 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19182 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019184 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19185 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19186 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19187 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19188 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19189 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19190 tcp-request content reject
19191
19192
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200191937.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019194--------------------------------------
19195
19196It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19197This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19198data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19199its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19200HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19201content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19202to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19203more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19204response are indexed.
19205
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019206Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19207 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19208 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19209 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19210 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19211 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19212 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214base : string
19215 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19216 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19217 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19218 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19219 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19220 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19221 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19222 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19223
19224 ACL derivatives :
19225 base : exact string match
19226 base_beg : prefix match
19227 base_dir : subdir match
19228 base_dom : domain match
19229 base_end : suffix match
19230 base_len : length match
19231 base_reg : regex match
19232 base_sub : substring match
19233
19234base32 : integer
19235 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19236 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19237 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019238 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19239 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19240 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019241
19242base32+src : binary
19243 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19244 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19245 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19246 per-URL counters.
19247
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019248baseq : string
19249 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19250 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19251 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19252 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19253
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019254capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19255 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19256 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19257 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19258
19259capture.req.method : string
19260 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19261 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19262 because it's allocated.
19263
19264capture.req.uri : string
19265 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19266 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19267 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19268 allocated.
19269
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019270capture.req.ver : string
19271 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19272 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19273 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19274
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019275capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19276 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19277 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19278 The first entry is an index of 0.
19279 See also: "capture response header"
19280
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019281capture.res.ver : string
19282 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19283 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19284 persistent flag.
19285
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019286req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019287 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19288 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19289 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019290
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019291req.body_param([<name>) : string
19292 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19293 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19294 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19295 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19296 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19297 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19298 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19299 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19300 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19301 given.
19302
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019303req.body_len : integer
19304 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19305 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019306 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19307 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019308
19309req.body_size : integer
19310 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019311 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19312 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019314req.cook([<name>]) : string
19315cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19316 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19317 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19318 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19319 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19320 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19321 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19322 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19323 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19324
19325 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019326 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19327 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19328 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19329 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19330 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19331 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19332 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19333 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019335req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19336cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19337 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19338 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019340req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19341cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19342 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19343 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19344 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19345 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019347cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19348 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19349 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19350 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19351 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019352 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019353 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19354 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19355 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19356 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019358hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19359 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19360 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19361 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19362 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019363 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019366 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19367 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19368 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19369 with headers such as User-Agent.
19370
19371 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19372 found.
19373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019374 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19375 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19376 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019377 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19380 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19381 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019382 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19383 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019385req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019386 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19387 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19388 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19389 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19390 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19391 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19392 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19393
19394 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19395 found.
19396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019397 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19398 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19399 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019400 with -1 being the last one.
19401
19402 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19403 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019405 ACL derivatives :
19406 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19407 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19408 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19409 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19410 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19411 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19412 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19413 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19414
19415req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19416hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19417 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19418 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019419 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19420 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19421 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19422
19423 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19424 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19425 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19426
19427 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428
19429req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19430hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19431 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19432 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19433 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019434 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19435 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19436 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19437 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19438 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019439
19440 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19441
19442 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019443
19444req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19445hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19446 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19447 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19448 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019449
19450 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19451
19452 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019453
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019454req.hdrs : string
19455 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19456 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19457 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19458 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19459
19460req.hdrs_bin : binary
19461 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19462 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19463 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19464 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19465 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19466 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19467
19468 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019469
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019470 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19471 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019473http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19474 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19475 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19476 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19477 basic auth is supported.
19478
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019479http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19480 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19481 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19482 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19483 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019484 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19485 basic auth is supported.
19486
19487 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019488 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19489 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19490 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19491 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019492
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019493http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019494 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19495 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19496 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019497
19498http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019499 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19500 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19501 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019502
19503http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019504 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19505 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19506 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019508http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019509 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19510 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19512 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019514method : integer + string
19515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19516 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19517 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19518 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19519 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19520 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19521 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019523 ACL derivatives :
19524 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019526 Example :
19527 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19528 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19529 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019531path : string
19532 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19533 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19534 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19535 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19536 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019537 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019540 ACL derivatives :
19541 path : exact string match
19542 path_beg : prefix match
19543 path_dir : subdir match
19544 path_dom : domain match
19545 path_end : suffix match
19546 path_len : length match
19547 path_reg : regex match
19548 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019549
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019550pathq : string
19551 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19552 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19553 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19554 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19555 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19556 result in both cases.
19557
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019558query : string
19559 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19560 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19561 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19562 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019563 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019564 which stops before the question mark.
19565
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019566req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19567 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19568 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19569 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19570 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019572req.ver : string
19573req_ver : string (deprecated)
19574 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19575 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19576 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019578 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019579 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019580
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019581res.body : binary
19582 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19583 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019584 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19585
19586 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019587
19588res.body_len : integer
19589 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19590 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019591 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19592
19593 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019594
19595res.body_size : integer
19596 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19597 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19598 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19599 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019600 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19601
19602 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019603
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019604res.cache_hit : boolean
19605 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19606 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19607
19608res.cache_name : string
19609 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19610 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19611 empty string.
19612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019613res.comp : boolean
19614 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19615 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19616 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019618res.comp_algo : string
19619 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19620 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19621 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623res.cook([<name>]) : string
19624scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19625 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19626 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019627 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19628
19629 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019631 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019632 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019634res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19635scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19636 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19637 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019638 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19639
19640 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019642res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19643scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19644 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19645 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019646 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19647
19648 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019650res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019651 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19652 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19653
19654 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19655 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19656
19657 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19658
19659 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019662 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19663 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19664
19665 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19666 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19667
19668 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019670res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19671shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019672 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19673 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19674
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019675 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019676 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19677
19678 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019681 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19682 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19683 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19684 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19685 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19686 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19687 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19688 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019689
19690res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19691shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019692 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19693 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19694
19695 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019696 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019697
19698 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019700res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19701shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019702 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19703 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19704
19705 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19706
19707 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019708
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019709res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19710 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19711 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19712 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019713 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19714
19715 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19718shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019719 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19720 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19721
19722 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19723
19724 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019725
19726res.hdrs : string
19727 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19728 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19729 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019730 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19731
19732 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019733
19734res.hdrs_bin : binary
19735 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19736 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19737 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19738 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19739 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19740 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19741 (length of 0 for both).
19742
19743 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19744
19745 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19746 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019748res.ver : string
19749resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19750 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019751 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19752
19753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019756 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019758set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19759 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19760 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019761 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019762 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19765 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019767status : integer
19768 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19769 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019770 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19771
19772 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019773
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019774unique-id : string
19775 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19776 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19777 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19778 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19779 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19780 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019782url : string
19783 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19784 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19785 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19786 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19787 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19788 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19789 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019791 ACL derivatives :
19792 url : exact string match
19793 url_beg : prefix match
19794 url_dir : subdir match
19795 url_dom : domain match
19796 url_end : suffix match
19797 url_len : length match
19798 url_reg : regex match
19799 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019801url_ip : ip
19802 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19803 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19804 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19805 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19806 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19807 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19808 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019810url_port : integer
19811 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19812 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19813 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19814 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019815
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019816urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19817url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19819 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019820 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19821 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19822 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19823 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019824 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19825 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019826 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19827 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829 ACL derivatives :
19830 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19831 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19832 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19833 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19834 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19835 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19836 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19837 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019838
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019840 Example :
19841 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19842 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19843 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19844 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019845
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019846urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019847 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19848 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19849 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019850
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019851url32 : integer
19852 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19853 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19854 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19855 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19856 is an unsigned integer.
19857
19858url32+src : binary
19859 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19860 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19861 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19862
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019863
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200198647.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019865---------------------------------------
19866
19867This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19868used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19869purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19870There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19871or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19872any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19873for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19874
19875internal.htx.data : integer
19876 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19877 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19878
19879internal.htx.free : integer
19880 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19881 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19882
19883internal.htx.free_data : integer
19884 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19885 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19886
19887internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019888 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19889 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19890 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019891
19892internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19893 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19894 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19895
19896internal.htx.size : integer
19897 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19898 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19899
19900internal.htx.used : integer
19901 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19902 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19903 direction.
19904
19905internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19906 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19907 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19908 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19909 of the special value :
19910 * head : The oldest inserted block
19911 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019912 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019913
19914internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19915 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19916 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19917 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19918 integer or one of the special value :
19919 * head : The oldest inserted block
19920 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019921 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019922
19923internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19924 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19925 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19926 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19927 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19928
19929 * head : The oldest inserted block
19930 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019931 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019932
19933internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19934 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19935 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19936 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19937 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19938
19939 * head : The oldest inserted block
19940 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019941 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019942
19943internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19944 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19945 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19946 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19947 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19948
19949 * head : The oldest inserted block
19950 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019951 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019952
19953internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19954 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19955 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19956 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19957 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19958
19959 * head : The oldest inserted block
19960 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019961 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019962
19963internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19964 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19965 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19966 it returns false.
19967
19968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200199697.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019970---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019971
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019972Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19973every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019974order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019975
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019976ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019977---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19978FALSE always_false never match
19979HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19980HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19981HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019982HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019983HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19984HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19985HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19986HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19987LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19988METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19989METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19990METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19991METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19992METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19993METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19994METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19995METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19996RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19997REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19998TRUE always_true always match
19999WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20000---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020001
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200038. Logging
20004----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020005
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020006One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20007provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20008very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20009provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20010state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020011to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020012headers.
20013
20014In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20015about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20016send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20017
20018 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20019 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20020 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20021 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20022 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020023 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020024 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020025
20026The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20027allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20028as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20029while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20030real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20031delay.
20032
20033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200348.1. Log levels
20035---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020036
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020037TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020038source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020039HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20040in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20041track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20042syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20043about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044
20045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200468.2. Log formats
20047----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020048
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020049HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020050and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20051slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20052options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020053
20054 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20055 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20056 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20057 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20058 extents.
20059
20060 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20061 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20062 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20063 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20064 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20065
20066 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20067 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20068 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20069 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20070 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20071
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020072 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20073 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20074 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20075 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20076
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020077 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20078
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20080specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20081field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20082servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20083always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20084identifier.
20085
20086Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20087 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20088 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20089 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20090 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20091
20092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200938.2.1. Default log format
20094-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020095
20096This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20097as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20098format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20099
20100 Example :
20101 listen www
20102 mode http
20103 log global
20104 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20105
20106 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20107 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20108 (www/HTTP)
20109
20110 Field Format Extract from the example above
20111 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20112 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20113 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20114 4 'to' to
20115 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20116 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20117
20118Detailed fields description :
20119 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20120 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20121 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20122 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20123 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20124 and processed the connection.
20125 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20126
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020127In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20128"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20129connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020131It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20132will eventually disappear.
20133
20134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201358.2.2. TCP log format
20136---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020137
20138The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20139is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20140information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20141counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20142emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20143environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20144the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20145sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020146specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20147not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20148fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20149marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020150
20151 Example :
20152 frontend fnt
20153 mode tcp
20154 option tcplog
20155 log global
20156 default_backend bck
20157
20158 backend bck
20159 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20160
20161 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20162 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20163 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20164
20165 Field Format Extract from the example above
20166 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20167 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20168 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20169 4 frontend_name fnt
20170 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20171 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20172 7 bytes_read* 212
20173 8 termination_state --
20174 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20175 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20176
20177Detailed fields description :
20178 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020179 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020180 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20181 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020182 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020183 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020184 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185
20186 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020187 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20188 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20189 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020190
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020191 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020192 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20193 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020194 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20195 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20196 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20197 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020198
20199 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20200 and processed the connection.
20201
20202 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20203 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20204 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20205 applications.
20206
20207 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20208 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20209 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20210 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20211 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20212
20213 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20214 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20215 See "Timers" below for more details.
20216
20217 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20218 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20219 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20220 "Timers" below for more details.
20221
20222 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020223 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020224 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20225 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20226 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20227 details.
20228
20229 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20230 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20231 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20232 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20233 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20234
20235 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20236 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20237 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20238 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20239 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20240 for more details.
20241
20242 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020243 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20245 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20246 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020247 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020248
20249 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20250 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20251 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20252 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20253 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20254 caused by a denial of service attack.
20255
20256 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20257 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20258 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20259 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20260 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20261 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20262 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20263 denial of service attack.
20264
20265 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20266 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20267 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20268 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20269 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20270 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20271 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20272 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20273 be processed than on other servers.
20274
20275 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20276 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20277 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20278 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020279 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020280 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20281 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20282 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20283 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20284 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20285 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20286 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20287 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20288
20289 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20290 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20291 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20292 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20293 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20294 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020295 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020296 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20297
20298 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20299 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20300 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20301 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20302 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20303 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020304 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020305 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20306 occurs.
20307
20308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203098.2.3. HTTP log format
20310----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020311
20312The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20313is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20314the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20315are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20316emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20317generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20318"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20319which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020320frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20321is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020322
20323Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20324slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20325with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20326
20327 Example :
20328 frontend http-in
20329 mode http
20330 option httplog
20331 log global
20332 default_backend bck
20333
20334 backend static
20335 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20336
20337 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20338 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20339 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020340 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020341
20342 Field Format Extract from the example above
20343 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20344 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020345 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020346 4 frontend_name http-in
20347 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020348 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020349 7 status_code 200
20350 8 bytes_read* 2750
20351 9 captured_request_cookie -
20352 10 captured_response_cookie -
20353 11 termination_state ----
20354 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20355 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20356 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20357 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20358 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020359
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020360Detailed fields description :
20361 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020362 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020363 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20364 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020365 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020366 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020367 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020368
20369 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020370 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20371 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20372 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020373
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020374 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020375 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020376
20377 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20378 and processed the connection.
20379
20380 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20381 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20382 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20383
20384 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20385 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20386 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20387 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20388 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20389 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20390
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020391 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20392 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20393 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020394 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020395 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20396 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020397 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020398 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399
20400 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20401 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020402 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020403
20404 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20405 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020406 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20407 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020408
20409 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20410 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20411 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20412 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20413 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020414 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20415 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020416
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020417 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020418 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20419 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20420 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20421 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20422 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20423 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020424 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020425
20426 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020427 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20428 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020429
20430 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20431 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020432 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20434 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20435 overflowing.
20436
20437 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20438 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20439 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20440 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20441 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20442 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20443 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20444 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20445
20446 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20447 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20448 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20449 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20450 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20451 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20452 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20453 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20454
20455 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20456 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20457 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20458 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20459 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20460 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20461 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20462
20463 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020464 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020465 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20466 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20467 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020468 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020469 system.
20470
20471 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20472 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20473 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20474 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20475 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20476 caused by a denial of service attack.
20477
20478 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20479 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20480 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20481 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20482 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20483 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20484 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20485 denial of service attack.
20486
20487 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20488 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20489 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20490 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20491 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20492 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20493 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20494 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20495 processed than on other servers.
20496
20497 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20498 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20499 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20500 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020501 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020502 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20503 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20504 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20505 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20506 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20507 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20508 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20509 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20510
20511 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20512 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20513 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20514 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20515 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20516 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020517 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020518 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20519
20520 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20521 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20522 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20523 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20524 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20525 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020526 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020527 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20528 occurs.
20529
20530 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20531 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20532 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20533 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20534 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20535 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20536 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20537 cookies" below for more details.
20538
20539 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20540 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20541 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20542 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20543 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20544 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20545 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20546 and cookies" below for more details.
20547
20548 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20549 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20550 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20551 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20552 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20553 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20554 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20555 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20556
20557
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205588.2.4. Custom log format
20559------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020560
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020561The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020562mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020563
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020564HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020565Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20566separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20567prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20568
20569Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20570variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020571("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020572
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020573If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020574as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020575less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20576the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20577
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020578Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20579"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20580delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20581preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020582
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020583Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20584'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20585https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20586such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20587
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020588Flags are :
20589 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020590 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020591 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20592 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020593
20594 Example:
20595
20596 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20598
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020599 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20600
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020601At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20602
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020603 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20604 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020605
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020606the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020607
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020608 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20609 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20610 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020611
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020612and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020614 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20615 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020616
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020617Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20618
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020619 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020620 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020621 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20622 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20623 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020624 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20625 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20626 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020627 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020628 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020629 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020630 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020631 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020632 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20633 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020634 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020635 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020636 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020637 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020638 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020639 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020640 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020641 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20642 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20643 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20644 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20645 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020646 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020647 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020648 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020649 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020650 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020651 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20652 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020653 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20654 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20655 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020656 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020657 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20658 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020659 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020660 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20661 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20662 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020663 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020664 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020665 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20666 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20667 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20668 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020669 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020670 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020671 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020672 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020673 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020674 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020675 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20676 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20677 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020678 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020679 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20680 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020681 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020682 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20683 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020684 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020685 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020686 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020687 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020688
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020689 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020690
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020691
206928.2.5. Error log format
20693-----------------------
20694
20695When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020696protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020697By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20698"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020699will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020700logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20701
20702The format looks like this :
20703
20704 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20705 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20706 Connection error during SSL handshake
20707
20708 Field Format Extract from the example above
20709 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20710 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20711 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20712 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20713 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20714
20715These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20716failures.
20717
20718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207198.3. Advanced logging options
20720-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020721
20722Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20723just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20724options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20725for more information about their usage.
20726
20727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20729------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020730
20731It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020732HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020733commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20734monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20735ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20736
20737 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20738 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20739 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20740 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20741
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020742 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20743 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020744
20745 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20746 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20747 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20748
20749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207508.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20751----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020752
20753The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20754what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20755or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020756"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020757just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20758log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20759after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20760is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20761with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20762with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20763
20764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207658.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20766------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020767
20768Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20769for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20770"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20771retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20772raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20773a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20774file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20775you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20776"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20777
20778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207798.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20780--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020781
20782Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20783multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20784them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20785"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20786logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20787error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20788and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20789too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20790useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20791alternative.
20792
20793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207948.4. Timing events
20795------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020796
20797Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20798reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20799the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20800frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020801mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20802addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20803
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020804Timings events in HTTP mode:
20805
20806 first request 2nd request
20807 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20808 t tr t tr ...
20809 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20810 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20811 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20812 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020813 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020814 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20815
20816Timings events in TCP mode:
20817
20818 TCP session
20819 |<----------------->|
20820 t t
20821 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20822 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20823 |<------ Tt ------->|
20824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020825 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020826 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020827 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20828 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20829 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020830 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020831 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20832 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20833 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20834 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020835
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020836 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20837 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20838 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020839 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20840 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20841 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20842 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20843 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20844 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020845
20846 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20847 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20848 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20849 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20850 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20851 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20852 request typed by hand during a test.
20853
20854 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20855 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020856 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020857 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20858 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20859 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20860 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020861
20862 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20863 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20864 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20865 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20866 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20867
20868 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20869 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20870 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20871 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20872 connection never established.
20873
20874 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20875 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20876 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20877 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20878 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20879 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20880 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20881 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20882 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20883 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20884 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20885
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020886 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20887 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20888 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20889 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20890 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20891 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20892
20893 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20894
20895 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20896 "Ta" can never be negative.
20897
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020898 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20899 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020900 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20901 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020902 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020903
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020904 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020905
20906 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020907 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20908 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020909
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020910 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20911 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20912 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20913 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20914 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20915 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20916 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20917 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20918
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020919These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20920protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20921that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020922due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20923"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20924that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020925
20926Most common cases :
20927
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020928 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20929 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20930 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20931 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20932 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020933 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020934 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20935 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20936 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20937 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20938 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020939 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940
20941 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20942 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20943 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20944 of ms on remote networks.
20945
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020946 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20947 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20948 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020949
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020950 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20951 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020952 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020953 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20954 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20955 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20956 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20957 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20958 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020959
20960Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20961
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020962 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020963 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020964 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020966 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020967 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20968 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020970 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020971 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20972 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20973 flags.
20974
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020975 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20976 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020977 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20978 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20979 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20980 the client connection was maintained open.
20981
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020982 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020983 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020984 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20986
20987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209888.5. Session state at disconnection
20989-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020990
20991TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20992"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
209932-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20994each of which has a special meaning :
20995
20996 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20997 session to terminate :
20998
20999 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21000
21001 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21002 server explicitly refused it.
21003
21004 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21005 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21006 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21007 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021008 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021009
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021010 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021011 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021012
21013 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21014 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21015 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21016 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21017 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21018
21019 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21020 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21021 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21022 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21023 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21024
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021025 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021026 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21027
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021028 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021029 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21030 backup connections when going up.
21031
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021032 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021033
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021034 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21035 send or receive data.
21036
21037 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21038 send or receive data.
21039
21040 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21041 with nothing left in the buffers.
21042
21043 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21044
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021045 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21047
21048 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21049 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21050 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21051 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21052 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21053
21054 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21055 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21056
21057 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21058 server (HTTP only).
21059
21060 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21061
21062 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21063 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21064 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21065
21066 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21067 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21068 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21069
21070 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21071
21072 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21073 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21074
21075 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21076 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21077 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21078
21079 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21080 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021081 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21082 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021083
21084 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21085 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21086 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21087 another server.
21088
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021089 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021090 server.
21091
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021092 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21093 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21094 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21095 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21096
21097 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21098 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21099 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21100 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21101
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021102 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21103 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21104 "use-server" rule).
21105
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021106 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21107
21108 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21109 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21110
21111 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21112
21113 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21114 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21115 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21116
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021117 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21118 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021119 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021120 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21121 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21122
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21124
21125 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21126 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21127
21128 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21129
21130 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21131
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021132The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21133was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021134helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21135starvation, attacks, etc...
21136
21137The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21138alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21139easier finding and understanding.
21140
21141 Flags Reason
21142
21143 -- Normal termination.
21144
21145 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021146 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21147 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21149
21150 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21151 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021152 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21153 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021154 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21155 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021156
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021157 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21158 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021159 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021160
21161 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21162 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21163 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21164
21165 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21166 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21167 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21168 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21169 the server takes too long to respond.
21170
21171 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21172 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21173 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21174 long a time to respond.
21175
21176 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21177 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21178 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021179 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021180 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21181 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021182
21183 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21184 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21185 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21186 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21187 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021188 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021189 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21190 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21191 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21192 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21193 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21194 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21195 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21196 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021197 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021198 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21199 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21200 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021201
21202 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21203 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021204 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21205 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21206 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21207 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021208
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021209 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021210 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21211
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021212 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021213 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21214 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021215 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021216 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21217 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21218
21219 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21220 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21221 503 or 504 here.
21222
21223 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021224 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021225 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21226 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21227 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21228
21229 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21230 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021231 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021232 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021233 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021234
21235 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21236 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21237 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21238 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21239 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21240 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021241 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021242
21243 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21244 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21245 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21246 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21247 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21248 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21249 solution is to fix the application.
21250
21251 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21252 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21253 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21254 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21255 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21256 external attacks.
21257
21258 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021259 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021260 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021261 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21262 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21263
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021264 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21265 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21266 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021267 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021268 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021269
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021270 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21271 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21272 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21273 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021274 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21275 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21276 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21277 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21278 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279
21280 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21281 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21282 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21283 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21284
21285 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21286 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21287 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21288 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21289
21290 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21291 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21292 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21293 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21294
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021295The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021296persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021297important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21298re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21299
21300 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21301
21302 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21303 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21304 set on a GET request.
21305
21306 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21307 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021308 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021309 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21310
21311 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21312 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21313 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21314
21315 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21316 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21317 already got a cookie.
21318
21319 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21320 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21321 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21322 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21323 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21324
21325 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21326 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21327 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21328
21329 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21330 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21331 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21332
21333 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21334 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21335
21336 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21337 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21338 then advertised in the response.
21339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213418.6. Non-printable characters
21342-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021343
21344In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21345consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21346converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21347prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21348being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21349escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21350is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21351'}' when logging headers.
21352
21353Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21354issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21355containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21356
21357Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21358the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21359performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21360
21361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213628.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21363---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021364
21365Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21366achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021367section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021368cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21369the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21370the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021371locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021372not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21373user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21374a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21375wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21376
21377 Examples :
21378 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21379 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21380
21381 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21382 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21383
21384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213858.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21386---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021387
21388Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21389proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21390the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21391server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21392
21393Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21394response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021395section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396
21397It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021398time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21399appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021400are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21401and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21402follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21403request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21404in the logs.
21405
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021406As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21407frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21408an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21409
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021410 Example :
21411 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21412 listen proxy-out
21413 mode http
21414 option httplog
21415 option logasap
21416 log global
21417 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21418
21419 # log the name of the virtual server
21420 capture request header Host len 20
21421
21422 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21423 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21424
21425 # log the beginning of the referrer
21426 capture request header Referer len 20
21427
21428 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21429 capture response header Server len 20
21430
21431 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21432 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21433
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021434 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021435 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21436
21437 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21438 capture response header Via len 20
21439
21440 # log the URL location during a redirection
21441 capture response header Location len 20
21442
21443 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21444 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21445 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21446 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21447 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21448
21449 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21450 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21451 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21452 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021453 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021454
21455 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21456 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21457 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21458 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21459 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021460 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021461
21462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214638.9. Examples of logs
21464---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021465
21466These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21467them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21468reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21469
21470 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21471 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21472 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21473
21474 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21475 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21476
21477 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21478 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21479 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21480
21481 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21482 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21483
21484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21485 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21486 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21487
21488 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021489 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021490 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21491 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21492
21493 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21494 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21495 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21496
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021497 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21498 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21499 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21500 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021501 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021502 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021503
21504 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021505 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021506
21507 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21508 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21509 Nothing was sent to any server.
21510
21511 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21512 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21513
21514 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21515 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021516 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021517 send a 408 return code to the client.
21518
21519 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21520 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21521
21522 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21523 5 seconds ("c----").
21524
21525 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21526 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021527 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021528
21529 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021530 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021531 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21532 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21533 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21534 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21535 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021536
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021537
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215389. Supported filters
21539--------------------
21540
21541Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21542accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21543unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21544
21545See also : "filter"
21546
215479.1. Trace
21548----------
21549
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021550filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021551
21552 Arguments:
21553 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21554 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21555
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021556 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021557
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021558 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021559 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21560 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21561 amount of the parsed data.
21562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021563 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021564
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021565This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21566callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21567information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21568filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21569
21570Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21571tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21572a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21573
21574
215759.2. HTTP compression
21576---------------------
21577
21578filter compression
21579
21580The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21581keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021582when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21583fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21584done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21585explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21586filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21587listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21588order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021589
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021590See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21591 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021592
21593
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200215949.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21595--------------------------------------------
21596
21597filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21598
21599 Arguments :
21600
21601 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21602 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21603 parsed.
21604
21605 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21606 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21607 part must be placed in its own scope.
21608
21609The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21610external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021611streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021612exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21613also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21614
21615SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21616the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21617
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021618For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021619"doc/SPOE.txt".
21620
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216219.4. Cache
21622----------
21623
21624filter cache <name>
21625
21626 Arguments :
21627
21628 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21629
21630The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21631"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021632cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021633other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21634case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21635is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21636filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021637listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21638order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021639
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021640See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21641 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21642
21643
216449.5. Fcgi-app
21645-------------
21646
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021647filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021648
21649 Arguments :
21650
21651 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21652
21653The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21654request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21655reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21656used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21657implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21658used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21659fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21660used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21661order.
21662
21663See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21664 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21665
21666
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100216679.6. OpenTracing
21668----------------
21669
21670The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21671HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21672of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21673Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21674
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021675This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021676
21677The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21678HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21679participates in the work of HAProxy.
21680
21681filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21682
21683 Arguments :
21684
21685 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21686 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21687 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21688 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21689 OpenTracing filters.
21690
21691 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21692 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21693 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21694 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21695 filter must have its own scope defined.
21696
21697More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021698of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021699
21700
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002170110. FastCGI applications
21702-------------------------
21703
21704HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21705feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21706the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21707FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21708servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21709FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21710backend.
21711
21712HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21713application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21714connection.
21715
2171610.1. Setup
21717-----------
21718
2171910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21720--------------------------
21721
21722fcgi-app <name>
21723 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21724 document root must be defined.
21725
21726acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21727 Declare or complete an access list.
21728
21729 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21730 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21731 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21732 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21733 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21734
21735docroot <path>
21736 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21737 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21738 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21739
21740index <script-name>
21741 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21742 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21743 is an optional setting.
21744
21745 Example :
21746 index index.php
21747
21748log-stderr global
21749log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021750 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021751 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21752
21753 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21754 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21755
21756pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21757 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21758 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21759 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21760
21761 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21762 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21763 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21764 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21765
21766 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21767 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21768
21769path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021770 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021771 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21772 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21773 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21774 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21775 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21776 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21777 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021778
21779 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021780 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021781 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21782 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21783 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21784 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021785
21786 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021787 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21788 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021789
21790option get-values
21791no option get-values
21792 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21793
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021794 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021795 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21796
21797 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21798 application will accept.
21799
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021800 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21801 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021802
21803 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021804 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021805 option is disabled.
21806
21807 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21808 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21809 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21810 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21811 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21812 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21813
21814option keep-conn
21815no option keep-conn
21816 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21817 sending a response.
21818
21819 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21820 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21821
21822option max-reqs <reqs>
21823 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21824 accept.
21825
21826 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21827 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21828 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21829 to 1.
21830
21831option mpxs-conns
21832no option mpxs-conns
21833 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21834
21835 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21836 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21837
21838set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21839 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21840 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21841 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21842 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21843
21844 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21845 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21846 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21847
21848 Example :
21849 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21850 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21851
21852 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21853
21854
2185510.1.2. Proxy section
21856---------------------
21857
21858use-fcgi-app <name>
21859 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21860
21861 Arguments :
21862 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21863
21864 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21865 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21866 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21867 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21868 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21869
21870 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21871 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21872 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21873 application are evaluated.
21874
21875
2187610.1.3. Example
21877---------------
21878
21879 frontend front-http
21880 mode http
21881 bind *:80
21882 bind *:
21883
21884 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21885 default_backend back-static
21886
21887 backend back-static
21888 mode http
21889 server www A.B.C.D:80
21890
21891 backend back-dynamic
21892 mode http
21893 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21894 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21895
21896 fcgi-app php-fpm
21897 log-stderr global
21898 option keep-conn
21899
21900 docroot /var/www/my-app
21901 index index.php
21902 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21903
21904
2190510.2. Default parameters
21906------------------------
21907
21908A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21909the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021910script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021911applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21912
21913 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21914 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21915 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21916 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21917 | | |
21918 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21919 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21920 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21921 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21922 | | application. |
21923 | | |
21924 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21925 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21926 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21927 | | |
21928 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21929 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21930 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21931 | | the application's configuration. |
21932 | | |
21933 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21934 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21935 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21936 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21937 | | |
21938 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21939 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21940 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21941 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21942 | | be defined. |
21943 | | |
21944 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21945 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21946 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21947 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21948 | | is not set too. |
21949 | | |
21950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21951 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21952 | | set. |
21953 | | |
21954 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21955 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21956 | | the request. |
21957 | | |
21958 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21959 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21960 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21961 | | |
21962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21963 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21964 | | script to process the request. |
21965 | | |
21966 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21967 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21968 | | |
21969 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21970 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21971 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21972 | | |
21973 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21974 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21975 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21976 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21977 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21978 | | |
21979 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21980 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21981 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21982 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21983 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21984 | | side. |
21985 | | |
21986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21987 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21988 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21989 | | connected to. |
21990 | | |
21991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21992 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21993 | | |
21994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020021995 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
21996 | | current HAProxy version. |
21997 | | |
21998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021999 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22000 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22001 | | |
22002 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22003
22004
2200510.3. Limitations
22006------------------
22007
22008The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22009way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22010during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22011establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22012application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22013or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22014message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22015these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22016and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22017
22018Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22019request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22020requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22021
22022About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22023into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22024fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22025"http-request" ones.
22026
22027Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22028FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22029processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22030must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22031here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022032
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022033
2203411. Address formats
22035-------------------
22036
22037Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22038address.
22039
22040This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22041The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22042of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22043equivalent is '::'.
22044
22045Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22046is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22047
22048This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22049family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22050
22051Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22052configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22053use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22054'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22055
22056Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22057socket type and the transport method.
22058
22059
2206011.1 Address family prefixes
22061----------------------------
22062
22063'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22064
22065'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22066 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22067 listening.
22068
22069'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22070 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22071 on the statement using this address, a port or
22072 a port range may or must be specified.
22073
22074'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22075 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22076 using this address, a port or a port range
22077 may or must be specified.
22078
22079'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22080 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22081 using this address, a port or a port range
22082 may or must be specified.
22083
22084'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22085 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22086 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22087 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22088 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22089 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22090
22091'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22092 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22093 start by slash '/'.
22094
22095
2209611.2 Socket type prefixes
22097-------------------------
22098
22099Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22100type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22101this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22102This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22103but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22104
22105Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22106instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22107
22108If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22109they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22110report this to the maintainers.
22111
22112'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22113 to "stream"
22114
22115'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22116 to "datagram".
22117
22118
2211911.3 Protocol prefixes
22120----------------------
22121
22122'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22123 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22124 socket type and transport method is forced to
22125 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22126 this address, a port or a port range can or
22127 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22128 of 'stream+ip@'.
22129
22130'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22131 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22132 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22133 statement using this address, a port or port
22134 range can or must be specified.
22135 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22136
22137'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22138 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22139 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22140 statement using this address, a port or port
22141 range can or must be specified.
22142 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22143
22144'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22145 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22146 socket type and transport method is forced to
22147 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22148 this address, a port or a port range can or
22149 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22150 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22151
22152'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22153 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22154 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22155 the statement using this address, a port or
22156 port range can or must be specified.
22157 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22158
22159'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22160 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22161 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22162 the statement using this address, a port or
22163 port range can or must be specified.
22164 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22165
22166'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22167 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22168 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22169
22170'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22171 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22172 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22173
22174In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22175QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22176
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022177/*
22178 * Local variables:
22179 * fill-column: 79
22180 * End:
22181 */